Merged revisions 53952-54987 via svnmerge from
svn+ssh://pythondev@svn.python.org/python/trunk ........ r53954 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-26 10:41:18 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 10 lines Do not copy free variables to locals in class namespaces. Fixes bug 1569356, but at the cost of a minor incompatibility in locals(). Add test that verifies that the class namespace is not polluted. Also clarify the behavior in the library docs. Along the way, cleaned up the dict_to_map and map_to_dict implementations and added some comments that explain what they do. ........ r53955 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-26 11:00:20 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 2 lines Fix assertion. ........ r53969 | neal.norwitz | 2007-02-26 14:41:45 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 3 lines When printing an unraisable error, don't print exceptions. before the name. This duplicates the behavior whening normally printing exceptions. ........ r53970 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-02-26 15:02:47 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 1 line Markup fix ........ r53975 | neal.norwitz | 2007-02-26 15:48:27 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 3 lines SF #1669182, 2.5 was already fixed. Just assert in 2.6 since string exceptions are gone. ........ r53976 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-02-26 15:54:17 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 1 line Add some items ........ r53981 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-26 17:01:59 -0800 (Mon, 26 Feb 2007) | 4 lines Fix long-standing bug in name mangling for package imports Reported by Mike Verdone. ........ r53993 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-27 08:00:06 -0800 (Tue, 27 Feb 2007) | 2 lines tabify ........ r53994 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-27 08:13:23 -0800 (Tue, 27 Feb 2007) | 5 lines tabify Note that ast.c still has a mix of tabs and spaces, because it attempts to use four-space indents for more of the new code. ........ r53996 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-27 09:24:48 -0800 (Tue, 27 Feb 2007) | 2 lines whitespace normalization ........ r53997 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-27 10:29:45 -0800 (Tue, 27 Feb 2007) | 24 lines Add checking for a number of metaclass error conditions. We add some new rules that are required for preserving internal invariants of types. 1. If type (or a subclass of type) appears in bases, it must appear before any non-type bases. If a non-type base (like a regular new-style class) occurred first, it could trick type into allocating the new class an __dict__ which must be impossible. 2. There are several checks that are made of bases when creating a type. Those checks are now repeated when assigning to __bases__. We also add the restriction that assignment to __bases__ may not change the metaclass of the type. Add new tests for these cases and for a few other oddball errors that were no previously tested. Remove a crasher test that was fixed. Also some internal refactoring: Extract the code to find the most derived metaclass of a type and its bases. It is now needed in two places. Rewrite the TypeError checks in test_descr to use doctest. The tests now clearly show what exception they expect to see. ........ r53998 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-02-27 10:33:31 -0800 (Tue, 27 Feb 2007) | 2 lines Add news about changes to metaclasses and __bases__ error checking. ........ r54016 | armin.rigo | 2007-02-28 01:25:29 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 3 lines Modify the segfaulting example to show why r53997 is not a solution to it. ........ r54022 | brett.cannon | 2007-02-28 10:15:00 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 2 lines Add a test for instantiating SyntaxError with no arguments. ........ r54026 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-02-28 10:27:41 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 1 line Docstring nit. ........ r54033 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-02-28 10:37:52 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 1 line Prepare collections module for pure python code entries. ........ r54053 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-02-28 22:16:43 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 1 line Add collections.NamedTuple ........ r54054 | neal.norwitz | 2007-02-28 23:04:41 -0800 (Wed, 28 Feb 2007) | 1 line Add Pat and Eric for work on PEP 3101 in the sandbox ........ r54061 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-03-01 06:36:12 -0800 (Thu, 01 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add NamedTuple ........ r54080 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-02 06:37:12 -0800 (Fri, 02 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1628895: some better tries to find HTML documentation in pydoc. ........ r54086 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-03-02 11:20:46 -0800 (Fri, 02 Mar 2007) | 1 line Fix embarrassing typo and fix constantification of None ........ r54088 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-02 12:30:14 -0800 (Fri, 02 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bugs #1668032, #1668036, #1669304: clarify behavior of PyMem_Realloc and _Resize. ........ r54114 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-04 09:18:54 -0800 (Sun, 04 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix a bug in test_dict and test_userdict, found at the PyPy sprint. ........ r54124 | skip.montanaro | 2007-03-04 12:52:28 -0800 (Sun, 04 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Teach setup.py how to find Berkeley DB on Macs using MacPorts. ........ r54125 | skip.montanaro | 2007-03-04 12:54:12 -0800 (Sun, 04 Mar 2007) | 1 line note MacPorts/BerkDB change in setup.py ........ r54136 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-04 23:52:01 -0800 (Sun, 04 Mar 2007) | 1 line Added Pete for 3101 too ........ r54138 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-05 08:31:54 -0800 (Mon, 05 Mar 2007) | 1 line Minor corrections to docs, and an explanation comentary ........ r54139 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-05 14:28:08 -0800 (Mon, 05 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1674228: when assigning a slice (old-style), check for the sq_ass_slice instead of the sq_slice slot. ........ r54149 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 01:33:01 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Nit: a struct field is set to GenericAlloc, not GenericAlloc(). ........ r54150 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 02:02:47 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1671450: add a section about subclassing builtin types to the "extending and embedding" tutorial. ........ r54152 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-06 02:41:24 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1121142: Implement ZipFile.open. ........ r54154 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 03:51:14 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines A test case for the fix in #1674228. ........ r54156 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 03:52:24 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1672481: fix bug in idlelib.MultiCall. ........ r54159 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 04:17:50 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 1 line Bug #1674503: close the file opened by execfile() in an error condition. ........ r54160 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 05:32:52 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Fix another reincarnation of bug #1576657 in defaultdict. ........ r54162 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 05:35:00 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines A test case for the defaultdict KeyError bug. ........ r54164 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 05:37:45 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1663234: you can now run doctest on test files and modules using "python -m doctest [-v] filename ...". ........ r54165 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-06 06:43:00 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #912410: Replace HTML entity references for attribute values in HTMLParser. ........ r54166 | skip.montanaro | 2007-03-06 07:41:38 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 1 line patch 1673619 - identify extension modules which cannot be built ........ r54167 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-03-06 07:50:01 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Patch #1646728: datetime.fromtimestamp fails with negative fractional times. With unittest. Somebody please backport to 2.5. ........ r54169 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 09:49:14 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix cmp vs. key argument for list.sort. ........ r54170 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 10:21:32 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Small nit, found by Neal. ........ r54171 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 10:29:58 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1602128: clarify that richcmp methods can return NotImplemented and should return True or False otherwise. ........ r54173 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 10:41:12 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1638879: don't accept strings with embedded NUL bytes in long(). ........ r54175 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 10:47:31 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1673121: update README wrt. OSX default shell. ........ r54177 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 10:59:11 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1654417: make operator.{get,set,del}slice use the full range of Py_ssize_t. ........ r54180 | walter.doerwald | 2007-03-06 12:38:57 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch for bug #1633621: if curses.resizeterm() or curses.resize_term() is called, update _curses.LINES, _curses.COLS, curses.LINES and curses.COLS. ........ r54182 | walter.doerwald | 2007-03-06 13:15:24 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Document change to curses. ........ r54188 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 16:34:46 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Variant of patch #697613: don't exit the interpreter on a SystemExit exception if the -i command line option or PYTHONINSPECT environment variable is given, but break into the interactive interpreter just like on other exceptions or normal program exit. (backport) ........ r54189 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 16:40:28 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #703779: unset __file__ in __main__ after running a file. This makes the filenames the warning module prints much more sensible when a PYTHONSTARTUP file is used. ........ r54192 | george.yoshida | 2007-03-06 20:21:18 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines add versionadded info ........ r54195 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-06 23:39:06 -0800 (Tue, 06 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #812285: allow multiple auth schemes in AbstractBasicAuthHandler. ........ r54197 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 00:31:51 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1001604: glob.glob() now returns unicode filenames if it was given a unicode argument and os.listdir() returns unicode filenames. ........ r54199 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 01:09:40 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patches #1550273, #1550272: fix a few bugs in unittest and add a comprehensive test suite for the module. ........ r54201 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 01:21:06 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #787789: allow to pass custom TestRunner instances to unittest's main() function. ........ r54202 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 01:34:45 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1669331: clarify shutil.copyfileobj() behavior wrt. file position. ........ r54204 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-07 03:04:33 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1115886: os.path.splitext('.cshrc') gives now ('.cshrc', ''). ........ r54206 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 03:37:42 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1675471: convert test_pty to unittest. ........ r54207 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-07 03:54:49 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Add some sanity checks to unittest.TestSuite's addTest(s) methods. Fixes #878275. ........ r54209 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-03-07 07:16:29 -0800 (Wed, 07 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Windows doesn't support negative timestamps. Skip the tests involving them if os.name == "nt". ........ r54219 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-08 05:42:43 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add missing ) in parenthical remark. ........ r54220 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-08 09:49:06 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix #1676656: \em is different from \emph... ........ r54222 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-08 10:37:31 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add a NEWS entry for rev. 54207,8. ........ r54225 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-03-08 11:24:27 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line SF 1676321: empty() returned wrong result ........ r54227 | collin.winter | 2007-03-08 11:58:14 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line Backported r54226 from p3yk: Move test_unittest, test_doctest and test_doctest2 higher up in the testing order. ........ r54230 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-03-08 13:33:47 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line SF #1637850: make_table in difflib did not work with unicode ........ r54232 | collin.winter | 2007-03-08 14:16:25 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1668482: don't use '-' in mkstemp ........ r54233 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-08 15:58:11 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 10 lines Introduce test.test_support.TransientResource. It's a context manager to surround calls to resources that may or may not be available. Specifying the expected exception and attributes to be raised if the resource is not available prevents overly broad catching of exceptions. This is meant to help suppress spurious failures by raising test.test_support.ResourceDenied if the exception matches. It would probably be good to go through the various network tests and surround the calls to catch connection timeouts (as done with test_socket_ssl in this commit). ........ r54234 | collin.winter | 2007-03-08 19:15:56 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1481079: Support of HTTP_REFERER in CGIHTTPServer.py ........ r54235 | collin.winter | 2007-03-08 19:26:32 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add NEWS item for patch #1481079 (r54234). ........ r54237 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-08 21:59:01 -0800 (Thu, 08 Mar 2007) | 1 line Fix SF #1676971, Complex OverflowError has a typo ........ r54239 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-09 04:58:41 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Typo. ........ r54240 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-09 07:35:55 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #957003: Implement smtplib.LMTP. ........ r54243 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 10:09:10 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1629566: clarify the docs on the return values of parsedate() and parsedate_tz() in email.utils and rfc822. ........ r54244 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-09 11:21:28 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Fix bug #1646630: ctypes.string_at(buf, 0) and ctypes.wstring_at(buf, 0) returned string up to the first NUL character. ........ r54245 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-09 11:36:01 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add Ziga Seilnacht. ........ r54247 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 12:33:07 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1491866: change the complex() constructor to allow parthensized forms. This means complex(repr(x)) now works instead of raising a ValueError. ........ r54248 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-09 12:39:22 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 7 lines Bug #1651235: When a tuple was passed to a ctypes function call, Python would crash instead of raising an error. The crash was caused by a section of code that should have been removed long ago, at that time ctypes had other ways to pass parameters to function calls. ........ r54250 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 15:30:39 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 1 line Hashing simplification pointed out by Thomas Wouters. ........ r54252 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 18:23:40 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 5 lines * Unlink test files before and after each test; hopefully this will cut down on recent buildbot failures in test_islink. * Drop safe_remove() in favor of test_support.unlink(). * Fix the indentation of test_samefile so that it runs. ........ r54253 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 18:51:26 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Bug #1531963: Make SocketServer.TCPServer's server_address always be equal to calling getsockname() on the server's socket. Will backport. ........ r54254 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-09 19:19:18 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Simplify a little by handling the TCP case first. Update to use predominant style of spaces around = in args list and print to stderr if debugging. ........ r54256 | collin.winter | 2007-03-09 19:35:34 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add proper attribution for a bug fix. ........ r54257 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-09 23:38:14 -0800 (Fri, 09 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Typos. ........ r54260 | collin.winter | 2007-03-10 06:33:32 -0800 (Sat, 10 Mar 2007) | 1 line Convert an assert to a raise so it works even in the presence of -O. ........ r54262 | collin.winter | 2007-03-10 06:41:48 -0800 (Sat, 10 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1599845: Add an option to disable the implicit calls to server_bind() and server_activate() in the constructors for TCPServer, SimpleXMLRPCServer and DocXMLRPCServer. ........ r54268 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-11 00:28:46 -0800 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add missing "return" statements in exception handler. ........ r54270 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-11 08:54:54 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1675981: remove unreachable code from type.__new__() method. __dict__ and __weakref__ are removed from the slots tuple earlier in the code, in the loop that mangles slot names. Will backport. ........ r54271 | collin.winter | 2007-03-11 09:00:20 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1192590: Fix pdb's "ignore" and "condition" commands so they trap the IndexError caused by passing in an invalid breakpoint number. Will backport. ........ r54274 | vinay.sajip | 2007-03-11 11:32:07 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 1 line Fix resource leak reported in SF #1516995. ........ r54278 | collin.winter | 2007-03-11 18:55:54 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1678662: ftp.python.org does not exist. So the testcode in urllib.py must use a more stable FTP. Will backport. ........ r54280 | barry.warsaw | 2007-03-11 20:20:01 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 8 lines Tokio Kikuchi's fix for SF bug #1629369; folding whitespace allowed in the display name of an email address, e.g. Foo \tBar <foo@example.com> Test case added by Barry. ........ r54282 | skip.montanaro | 2007-03-11 20:30:50 -0700 (Sun, 11 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Sane humans would call these invalid tests, but Andrew McNamara pointed out that given the inputs in these tests Excel does indeed produce the output these tests expect. Document that for future confused folks. ........ r54283 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-12 03:50:39 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1675511: Use -Kpic instead of -xcode=pic32 on Solaris/x86. ........ r54285 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-12 04:01:10 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1677862: Require a space or tab after import in .pth files. ........ r54287 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-12 06:17:36 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 8 lines Backport from Py3k branch: Patch #1591665: implement the __dir__() special function lookup in PyObject_Dir. Had to change a few bits of the patch because classobjs and __methods__ are still in Py2.6. ........ r54288 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-12 07:30:05 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Bug #1678647: write a newline after printing an exception in any case, even when converting the value to a string failed. ........ r54290 | collin.winter | 2007-03-12 08:57:19 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1678088: convert test_operations to use unittest, fold the result into test_dict. ........ r54291 | collin.winter | 2007-03-12 09:11:39 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Bug #742342: make Python stop segfaulting on infinitely-recursive reload()s. Fixed by patch #922167. Will backport. ........ r54292 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-12 09:15:09 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Typo fix. ........ r54295 | collin.winter | 2007-03-12 10:24:07 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1670993: Refactor test_threadedtempfile.py to use unittest. ........ r54296 | tim.peters | 2007-03-12 11:07:52 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Whitespace normalization. ........ r54297 | tim.peters | 2007-03-12 11:09:22 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Set missing svn:eol-style property on text files. ........ r54315 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-12 19:34:09 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 8 lines Add test.test_support.transient_internet . Returns a context manager that nests test.test_support.TransientResource context managers that capture exceptions raised when the Internet connection is flaky. Initially using in test_socket_ssl but should probably be expanded to cover any test that should not raise the captured exceptions if the Internet connection works. ........ r54316 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-12 20:05:40 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix a typo where the variable name was not updated. ........ r54318 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-12 21:59:58 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add Jerry Seutter for a bunch of his recent patches refactoring tests ........ r54319 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-12 22:07:14 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 7 lines Add some other acks for recent checkins: Brian Leair - 922167 Tomer Filiba - 1591665 Jeremy Jones - 1192590 ........ r54321 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-12 22:31:38 -0700 (Mon, 12 Mar 2007) | 9 lines Fix some style nits: * lines too long * wrong indentation * space after a function name * wrong function name in error string * simplifying some logic Also add an error check to PyDict_SetItemString. ........ r54322 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 00:23:16 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Typo and grammar fixes. ........ r54323 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 00:50:57 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1679379: add documentation for fnmatch.translate(). ........ r54325 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 00:57:51 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1642844: comments to clarify the complexobject constructor. ........ r54326 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 01:14:27 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1668100: urllib2 now correctly raises URLError instead of OSError if accessing a local file via the file:// protocol fails. ........ r54327 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 02:32:11 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1635454: the csv.DictWriter class now includes the offending field names in its exception message if you try to write a record with a dictionary containing fields not in the CSV field names list. ........ r54328 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 02:41:31 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1555098: use str.join() instead of repeated string concatenation in robotparser. ........ r54329 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 03:06:48 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1542681: add entries for "with", "as" and "CONTEXTMANAGERS" to pydoc's help keywords. ........ r54331 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 03:19:22 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1569798: fix a bug in distutils when building Python from a directory within sys.exec_prefix. ........ r54333 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-13 03:24:00 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1449244: Support Unicode strings in email.message.Message.{set_charset,get_content_charset}. Will backport. ........ r54335 | lars.gustaebel | 2007-03-13 03:47:19 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 34 lines This is the implementation of POSIX.1-2001 (pax) format read/write support. The TarInfo class now contains all necessary logic to process and create tar header data which has been moved there from the TarFile class. The fromtarfile() method was added. The new path and linkpath properties are aliases for the name and linkname attributes in correspondence to the pax naming scheme. The TarFile constructor and classmethods now accept a number of keyword arguments which could only be set as attributes before (e.g. dereference, ignore_zeros). The encoding and pax_headers arguments were added for pax support. There is a new tarinfo keyword argument that allows using subclassed TarInfo objects in TarFile. The boolean TarFile.posix attribute is deprecated, because now three tar formats are supported. Instead, the desired format for writing is specified using the constants USTAR_FORMAT, GNU_FORMAT and PAX_FORMAT as the format keyword argument. This change affects TarInfo.tobuf() as well. The test suite has been heavily reorganized and partially rewritten. A new testtar.tar was added that contains sample data in many formats from 4 different tar programs. Some bugs and quirks that also have been fixed: Directory names do no longer have a trailing slash in TarInfo.name or TarFile.getnames(). Adding the same file twice does not create a hardlink file member. The TarFile constructor does no longer need a name argument. The TarFile._mode attribute was renamed to mode and contains either 'r', 'w' or 'a'. ........ r54336 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 05:34:25 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Bug #1622896: fix a rare corner case where the bz2 module raised an error in spite of a succesful compression. ........ r54338 | lars.gustaebel | 2007-03-13 08:47:07 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Quick fix for tests that fail on systems with an encoding other than 'iso8859-1'. ........ r54339 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 10:43:32 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1603688: ConfigParser.SafeConfigParser now checks values that are set for invalid interpolation sequences that would lead to errors on reading back those values. ........ r54341 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 11:15:41 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1581073: add a flag to textwrap that prevents the dropping of whitespace while wrapping. ........ r54343 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 11:24:40 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1605192: list allowed states in error messages for imaplib. ........ r54344 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 11:31:49 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1537850: tempfile.NamedTemporaryFile now has a "delete" parameter which can be set to False to prevent the default delete-on-close behavior. ........ r54345 | collin.winter | 2007-03-13 11:53:04 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 9 lines Add acks for recent patch checkins: Arvin Schnell - 1668482 S?\195?\169bastien Martini - 1481079 Heiko Wundram - 1491866 Damon Kohler - 1545011 Peter Parente - 1599845 Bjorn Lindqvist - 1678662 ........ r54346 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 12:00:36 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Acks for recent patches. ........ r54347 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 12:18:18 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Fix a tab. ........ r54348 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 12:32:21 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1533909: the timeit module now accepts callables in addition to strings for the code to time and the setup code. Also added two convenience functions for instantiating a Timer and calling its methods. ........ r54352 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 13:02:57 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1530482: add pydoc.render_doc() which returns the documentation for a thing instead of paging it to stdout, which pydoc.doc() does. ........ r54357 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-13 13:42:52 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1649190: Adding support for _Bool to ctypes as c_bool, by David Remahl. ........ r54358 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 13:46:32 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1444529: the builtin compile() now accepts keyword arguments. (backport) ........ r54359 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-13 14:01:39 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add versionadded marker for ctypes.c_bool. ........ r54360 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 14:08:15 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1393667: pdb now has a "run" command which restarts the debugged Python program, optionally with different arguments. ........ r54361 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 14:32:01 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Deprecate commands.getstatus(). ........ r54362 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 14:32:56 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines NEWS entry for getstatus() deprecation. ........ r54363 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 14:58:44 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1429539: pdb now correctly initializes the __main__ module for the debugged script, which means that imports from __main__ work correctly now. ........ r54364 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 15:07:36 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #957650: "%var%" environment variable references are now properly expanded in ntpath.expandvars(), also "~user" home directory references are recognized and handled on Windows. ........ r54365 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 15:16:30 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1194449: correctly detect unbound methods in pydoc. ........ r54367 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-13 15:49:43 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Patch #1185447: binascii.b2a_qp() now correctly quotes binary characters with ASCII value less than 32. Also, it correctly quotes dots only if they occur on a single line, as opposed to the previous behavior of quoting dots if they are the second character of any line. ........ r54368 | collin.winter | 2007-03-13 16:02:15 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 1 line Inline PyImport_GetModulesReloading(). ........ r54371 | barry.warsaw | 2007-03-13 21:59:50 -0700 (Tue, 13 Mar 2007) | 6 lines SF bug #1582282; decode_header() incorrectly splits not-conformant RFC 2047-like headers where there is no whitespace between encoded words. This fix changes the matching regexp to include a trailing lookahead assertion that the closing ?= must be followed by whitespace, newline, or end-of-string. This also changes the regexp to add the MULTILINE flag. ........ r54372 | gregory.p.smith | 2007-03-14 00:17:40 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 2 lines correct order and names of the less often used keyword parameters. ........ r54373 | gregory.p.smith | 2007-03-14 00:19:50 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Its time to stop listing (Unix, Windows) when we really mean "everything but Mac OS 9" now that nobody is likely to use Python on Mac OS 9 and most of the (Mac) platform items are all OS X special API specific since OS X is unixy enough for these modules to be available out of the box. ........ r54376 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-14 01:27:52 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Bug #767111: fix long-standing bug in urllib which caused an AttributeError instead of an IOError when the server's response didn't contain a valid HTTP status line. ........ r54378 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-14 05:24:09 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1680015: Don't modify __slots__ tuple if it contains an unicode name. Remove a reference leak that happened if the name could not be converted to string. Will backport. ........ r54386 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-14 13:02:31 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1559413: Fix test_cmd_line if sys.executable contains a space. Will backport. ........ r54389 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-14 14:40:13 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Note how test_socket_ssl has various exceptions that deal with a flaky Net connection are silenced. ........ r54390 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-14 14:44:15 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Raise ResourceDenied in test_urllib2net when the Net connection goes bad. ........ r54391 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-14 21:41:20 -0700 (Wed, 14 Mar 2007) | 1 line Wrap a long line and fix a typo (is -> if) ........ r54392 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-15 00:38:14 -0700 (Thu, 15 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1680978: consistently use "alive" instead of "active" in the thread lib doc. ........ r54394 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-15 00:41:30 -0700 (Thu, 15 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1681153: the wave module now closes a file object it opened if initialization failed. ........ r54397 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-15 04:44:55 -0700 (Thu, 15 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1462488: prevent a segfault in object_reduce_ex() by splitting the implementation for __reduce__ and __reduce_ex__ into two separate functions. Fixes bug #931877. Will backport. ........ r54404 | collin.winter | 2007-03-15 21:11:30 -0700 (Thu, 15 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1642547: Fix an error/crash when encountering syntax errors in complex if statements. Will backport. ........ r54406 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-16 00:55:09 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Bug #1681228: the webbrowser module now correctly uses the default GNOME or KDE browser, depending on whether there is a session of one of those present. Also, it tries the Windows default browser before trying Mozilla variants. (backport) ........ r54407 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-16 01:22:40 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Patch #1273829: os.walk() now has a "followlinks" parameter. If set to True (which is not the default), it visits symlinks pointing to directories. ........ r54408 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-16 01:24:21 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add \versionadded tag. ........ r54409 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-16 01:33:47 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 2 lines RFE #1670167: fix in isinstance() docs. ........ r54412 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-16 04:59:38 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1623563: allow __class__ assignment for classes with __slots__. The old and the new class are still required to have the same slot names, but the order in which they are specified is not relevant. ........ r54413 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-16 05:11:11 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Whitespace cleanup. Also remove the empty lines from the previous check in. ........ r54414 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-03-16 07:49:11 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Remove warning: funcion declaration isn't a prototype ........ r54415 | jeremy.hylton | 2007-03-16 08:59:47 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 11 lines Clean up formatting of this file. The file should now follow PEP 7, except that it uses 4 space indents (in the style of Py3k). This particular code would be really hard to read with the regular tab idents. Other changes: - reflow long lines - change multi-line conditionals to have test at end of line ........ r54417 | collin.winter | 2007-03-16 14:13:35 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1676994: Refactor test_popen2 to use unittest. ........ r54418 | collin.winter | 2007-03-16 14:15:35 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 1 line Remove test/output/test_popen2 (missed in r54417). ........ r54419 | collin.winter | 2007-03-16 15:16:08 -0700 (Fri, 16 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch 1339796: add a relpath() function to os.path. ........ r54421 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-17 09:08:45 -0700 (Sat, 17 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Patch #1675423: PyComplex_AsCComplex() now tries to convert an object to complex using its __complex__() method before falling back to the __float__() method. Therefore, the functions in the cmath module now can operate on objects that define a __complex__() method. (backport) ........ r54423 | gregory.p.smith | 2007-03-17 15:33:35 -0700 (Sat, 17 Mar 2007) | 2 lines move note to the correct section ........ r54426 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-18 01:25:00 -0700 (Sun, 18 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1682878: the new socket methods are recv_into and recvfrom_into, not *_buf. ........ r54432 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-18 11:28:25 -0700 (Sun, 18 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1678339: test case for bug in difflib. ........ r54439 | collin.winter | 2007-03-19 11:52:08 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Patch #1630118: add a SpooledTemporaryFile class to tempfile. ........ r54441 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-19 12:02:48 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1683328: fixes and enhancements for "unparse" demo. ........ r54456 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 22:07:28 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add some doc that was left out from some change to platform.py ........ r54457 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 22:08:23 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add a comment about 3k migration ........ r54458 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 22:21:21 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Get rid of deprecation warning when testing commands.getstatus() ........ r54459 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 22:23:09 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Try backing out 54407 to see if it corrects the problems on the Windows buildbots. This rev was backported, so we will need to keep both branches in sync, pending the outcome of the test after this checkin. ........ r54460 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 23:13:25 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Try to make this test more resistant to dropping from previous runs (ie, files that may exist but cause the test to fail). Should be backported (assuming it works :-) ........ r54461 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 23:16:26 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 1 line Try to make this test more resistant to dropping from previous runs (ie, files that may exist but cause the test to fail). Should be backported (assuming it works :-) ........ r54462 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-19 23:53:17 -0700 (Mon, 19 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Try to be a little more resilient to errors. This might help the test pass, but my guess is that it won't. I'm guessing that some other test is leaving this file open which means it can't be removed under Windows AFAIK. ........ r54463 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-20 01:14:57 -0700 (Tue, 20 Mar 2007) | 8 lines Try to get test_urllib to pass on Windows by closing the file. I'm guessing that's the problem. h.getfile() must be called *after* h.getreply() and the fp can be None. I'm not entirely convinced this is the best fix (or even correct). The buildbots will tell us if things improve or not. I don't know if this needs to be backported (assuming it actually works). ........ r54465 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-03-20 14:27:24 -0700 (Tue, 20 Mar 2007) | 1 line Extend work on rev 52962 and 53829 eliminating redundant PyObject_Hash() calls and fixing set/dict interoperability. ........ r54468 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-20 16:05:14 -0700 (Tue, 20 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix for glob.py if filesystem encoding is None. ........ r54479 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-20 23:39:48 -0700 (Tue, 20 Mar 2007) | 1 line Remove unused file spotted by Paul Hankin ........ r54480 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-21 02:00:39 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1682205: a TypeError while unpacking an iterable is no longer masked by a generic one with the message "unpack non-sequence". ........ r54482 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-21 02:10:29 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 2 lines New test for rev. 54407 which only uses directories under TESTFN. ........ r54483 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-21 02:16:53 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1684834: document some utility C API functions. ........ r54485 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-21 04:51:25 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Fix #1684254: split BROWSER contents with shlex to avoid displaying 'URL'. ........ r54487 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-03-21 07:32:43 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add comments on maintenance of this file ........ r54489 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-03-21 09:57:32 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 1 line Fix sentence, and fix typo in example ........ r54490 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-03-21 09:59:20 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 1 line Put code examples at left margin instead of indenting them ........ r54491 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-21 12:41:24 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 1 line Minor clarification, saying that blocking means no timeout (from bug #882297) ........ r54492 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-21 13:07:56 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1675967: re patterns pickled with older Python versions can now be unpickled. Will backport. ........ r54495 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-03-21 13:33:57 -0700 (Wed, 21 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add test and fix for fromkeys() optional argument. ........ r54524 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-22 01:05:45 -0700 (Thu, 22 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1685704: use -m switch in timeit docs. ........ r54533 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-22 12:44:31 -0700 (Thu, 22 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Back out "Patch #1643874: memory leak in ctypes fixed." The code in this patch leaves no way to give up the ownership of a BSTR instance. ........ r54538 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-22 13:34:37 -0700 (Thu, 22 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Explain the purpose of the b_needsfree flag (forward ported from release25-maint). ........ r54539 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-03-22 21:58:42 -0700 (Thu, 22 Mar 2007) | 12 lines - Bug #1683368: The object.__init__() and object.__new__() methods are now stricter in rejecting excess arguments. The only time when either allows excess arguments is when it is not overridden and the other one is. For backwards compatibility, when both are overridden, it is a deprecation warning (for now; maybe a Py3k warning later). When merging this into 3.0, the warnings should become errors. Note: without the change to string.py, lots of spurious warnings happen. What's going on there? ........ r54540 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-22 22:17:23 -0700 (Thu, 22 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add Mark Dickinson for SF # 1675423. ........ r54541 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-23 03:35:49 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1686451: Fix return type for PySequence_{Count,Index,Fast_GET_SIZE}. Will backport. ........ r54543 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-03-23 06:27:15 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Bug #978833: Revert r50844, as it broke _socketobject.dup. Will backport. ........ r54545 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-03-23 11:53:03 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 8 lines Add a type.__init__() method that enforces the same signature as type.__new__(), and then calls object.__init__(cls), just to be anal. This allows us to restore the code in string.py's _TemplateMetaclass that called super(...).__init__(name, bases, dct), which I commented out yesterday since it broke due to the stricter argument checking added to object.__init__(). ........ r54546 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-23 11:54:07 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Added a 'create_connect()' function to socket.py, which creates a connection with an optional timeout, and modified httplib.py to use this function in HTTPConnection. Applies patch 1676823. ........ r54547 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-03-23 12:39:01 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Add note about type.__init__(). ........ r54553 | thomas.heller | 2007-03-23 12:55:27 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Prevent creation (followed by a segfault) of array types when the size overflows the valid Py_ssize_t range. Check return values of PyMem_Malloc. Will backport to release25-maint. ........ r54555 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-23 13:23:08 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 6 lines Surrounded with try/finally to socket's default timeout setting changes in the tests, so failing one test won't produce strange results in others. Also relaxed the timeout settings in the test (where actually the value didn't mean anything). ........ r54556 | collin.winter | 2007-03-23 15:24:39 -0700 (Fri, 23 Mar 2007) | 1 line Make test_relpath() pass on Windows. ........ r54559 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-03-24 07:24:26 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 6 lines Patch #1489771: update syntax rules in Python Reference Manual. Python 2.5 added support for explicit relative import statements and yield expressions, which were missing in the manual. Also fix grammar productions that used the names from the Grammar file, markup that broke the generated grammar.txt, and wrap some lines that broke the pdf output. Will backport. ........ r54565 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-24 15:20:34 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Remove typo accent. ........ r54566 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-24 15:27:56 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Revert accidental change. ........ r54567 | brett.cannon | 2007-03-24 18:32:36 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Change the docs to no longer claim that unittest is preferred over doctest for regression tests. ........ r54568 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-24 18:53:21 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Redone the tests, using the infrastructure already present for threading and socket serving. ........ r54570 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-24 20:20:05 -0700 (Sat, 24 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Closing the HTTP connection after each test, and listening more. ........ r54572 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-25 11:44:35 -0700 (Sun, 25 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54573 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-25 12:04:55 -0700 (Sun, 25 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54580 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-26 13:18:31 -0700 (Mon, 26 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Added an optional timeout to FTP class. Also I started a test_ftplib.py file to test the ftp lib (right now I included a basic test, the timeout one, and nothing else). ........ r54581 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-26 13:28:28 -0700 (Mon, 26 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Some nits. ........ r54582 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-26 13:56:09 -0700 (Mon, 26 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Forgot to add the file before the previous commit, here go the ftplib tests. ........ r54585 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-27 11:23:21 -0700 (Tue, 27 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Added an optional timeout to poplib.POP3. Also created a test_poplib.py file with a basic test and the timeout ones. Docs are also updated. ........ r54586 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-27 11:50:29 -0700 (Tue, 27 Mar 2007) | 3 lines The basic test cases of poplib.py. ........ r54594 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-27 20:45:20 -0700 (Tue, 27 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Bug 1688393. Adds a control of negative values in socket.recvfrom, which caused an ugly crash. ........ r54599 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-28 11:25:54 -0700 (Wed, 28 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Added timeout to smtplib (to SMTP and SMTP_SSL). Also created the test_smtplib.py file, with a basic test and the timeout ones. Docs are updated too. ........ r54603 | collin.winter | 2007-03-28 16:34:06 -0700 (Wed, 28 Mar 2007) | 3 lines Consolidate patches #1690164, 1683397, and 1690169, all of which refactor XML-related test suites. The patches are applied together because they use a common output/xmltests file. Thanks to Jerry Seutter for all three patches. ........ r54604 | collin.winter | 2007-03-28 19:28:16 -0700 (Wed, 28 Mar 2007) | 1 line Make test_zipfile clean up its temporary files properly. ........ r54605 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-29 00:41:32 -0700 (Thu, 29 Mar 2007) | 2 lines These are actually methods. ........ r54606 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-29 05:42:07 -0700 (Thu, 29 Mar 2007) | 4 lines In Windows' time.clock(), when QueryPerformanceFrequency() fails, the C lib's clock() is used, but it must be divided by CLOCKS_PER_SEC as for the POSIX implementation (thanks to #pypy). ........ r54608 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-29 11:22:35 -0700 (Thu, 29 Mar 2007) | 5 lines Added timout parameter to telnetlib.Telnet. Also created test_telnetlib.py with a basic test and timeout ones. Docs are also updated. ........ r54613 | facundo.batista | 2007-03-30 06:00:35 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Added the posibility to pass the timeout to FTP.connect, not only when instantiating the class. Docs and tests are updated. ........ r54614 | collin.winter | 2007-03-30 07:01:25 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 1 line Bug #1688274: add documentation for C-level class objects. ........ r54615 | marc-andre.lemburg | 2007-03-30 08:01:42 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Bump the patch level version of distutils since there were a few bug fixes since the 2.5.0 release. ........ r54617 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 08:49:05 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54618 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 10:39:39 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Label name fix. ........ r54619 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 10:47:21 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Duplicate label fix. ........ r54620 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 10:48:39 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54623 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-03-30 11:00:15 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 1 line Add item. (Oops, accidentally checked this in on my branch) ........ r54624 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 12:01:38 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Duplicate label fix. ........ r54625 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-30 12:14:02 -0700 (Fri, 30 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54629 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-31 03:17:31 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 2 lines repair string literal. ........ r54630 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-31 04:54:58 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54631 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-31 04:58:36 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Duplicate label fix. ........ r54632 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-31 04:59:54 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 2 lines Typo fix. ........ r54633 | neal.norwitz | 2007-03-31 11:54:18 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 1 line Fix method names. Will backport. ........ r54634 | georg.brandl | 2007-03-31 11:56:11 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 4 lines Bug #1655392: don't add -L/usr/lib/pythonX.Y/config to the LDFLAGS returned by python-config if Python was built with --enable-shared because that prevented the shared library from being used. ........ r54637 | collin.winter | 2007-03-31 12:31:34 -0700 (Sat, 31 Mar 2007) | 1 line Shut up an occaisonal buildbot error due to test files being left around. ........ r54644 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-01 11:24:22 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 11 lines SF #1685563, MSVCCompiler creates redundant and long PATH strings If MSVCCompiler.initialize() was called multiple times, the path would get duplicated. On Windows, this is a problem because the path is limited to 4k. There's no benefit in adding a path multiple times, so prevent that from occuring. We also normalize the path before checking for duplicates so things like /a and /a/ won't both be stored. Will backport. ........ r54646 | brett.cannon | 2007-04-01 11:47:27 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 8 lines time.strptime's caching of its locale object was being recreated when the locale changed but not used during the function call it was recreated during. The test in this checkin is untested (OS X does not have the proper locale support for me to test), although the fix for the bug this deals with was tested by the OP (#1290505). Once the buildbots verify the test at least doesn't fail it becomes a backport candidate. ........ r54647 | brett.cannon | 2007-04-01 12:46:19 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Fix the test for recreating the locale cache object by not worrying about if one of the test locales cannot be set. ........ r54649 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 14:29:15 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Fix a lot of markup and meta-information glitches. ........ r54650 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 14:39:52 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Another fix. ........ r54651 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 15:39:10 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Lots of explicit class names for method and member descs. ........ r54652 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 15:40:12 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Explicit class names. ........ r54653 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 15:47:31 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Some semantic fixes. ........ r54654 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 16:29:10 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Remove bogus entry. ........ r54655 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-01 16:31:30 -0700 (Sun, 01 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Fix the class name of strings. ........ r54658 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-02 10:29:30 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 1 line SF #1693079: Cannot save empty array in shelve ........ r54663 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-02 15:54:21 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Array module's buffer interface can now handle empty arrays. ........ r54664 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-04-02 16:55:37 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 5 lines Fix warnings about object.__init__() signature. Two (test_array and test_descr) were bug IMO; the third (copy_reg) is a work-around which recognizes that object.__init__() doesn't do anything. ........ r54666 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-02 17:02:11 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 1 line SF 1602378 Clarify docstrings for bisect ........ r54668 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-02 18:39:43 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 3 lines SF #1382213: Tutorial section 9.5.1 ignores MRO for new-style classes ........ r54669 | matthias.klose | 2007-04-02 21:35:59 -0700 (Mon, 02 Apr 2007) | 4 lines - Fix an off-by-one bug in locale.strxfrm(). patch taken from http://bugs.debian.org/416934. ........ r54671 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-03 00:04:27 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 9 lines Fix the strange case of \begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{...} where \ifx#1\@undefined ended up comparing N and N, therefore executing the true part of the conditional, blowing up at \@undefined. ........ r54672 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-03 07:05:08 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Now using unittest for the tests infraestructure. Also split the tests in those who need the network, and that who doesn't. ........ r54673 | walter.doerwald | 2007-04-03 09:08:10 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Move the functionality for catching warnings in test_warnings.py into a separate class to that reusing the functionality in test_structmembers.py doesn't rerun the tests from test_warnings.py. ........ r54674 | walter.doerwald | 2007-04-03 09:16:24 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Document that CatchWarningTests is reused by test_structmembers.py. ........ r54675 | walter.doerwald | 2007-04-03 09:53:43 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Add tests for the filename. Test that the stacklevel is handled correctly. ........ r54676 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-03 10:29:48 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 6 lines Added a SSL server to test_socket_ssl.py to be able to test locally. Now, it checks if have openssl available and run those specific tests (it starts openssl at the beggining of all the tests and then kills it at the end). ........ r54677 | walter.doerwald | 2007-04-03 11:33:29 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 6 lines Implement a contextmanager test.test_support.catch_warning that can be used to catch the last warning issued by the warning framework. Change test_warnings.py and test_structmembers.py to use this new contextmanager. ........ r54678 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-03 14:15:34 -0700 (Tue, 03 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Changed the whole structure of startup and checking if the server is available. Hope to not get more false alarms. ........ r54681 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-04 07:10:40 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Fixed the way that the .pem files are looked for, and changed how to kill the process in win32 to use the _handle attribute. ........ r54682 | guido.van.rossum | 2007-04-04 10:43:02 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Fix a race condition in this test -- instead of assuming that it will take the test server thread at most 0.5 seconds to get ready, use an event variable. ........ r54683 | collin.winter | 2007-04-04 11:14:17 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 1 line Clean up imports. ........ r54684 | collin.winter | 2007-04-04 11:16:24 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 1 line Stop using test_support.verify(). ........ r54685 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-04-04 11:30:36 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1686475: Support stat'ing open files on Windows again. Will backport to 2.5. ........ r54687 | collin.winter | 2007-04-04 11:33:40 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 1 line Make test_getopt use unittest. ........ r54688 | collin.winter | 2007-04-04 11:36:30 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 1 line Make test_softspace use unittest. ........ r54689 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-04-04 11:38:47 -0700 (Wed, 04 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Fix WalkTests.test_traversal() on Windows. The cleanup in MakedirTests.setUp() can now be removed. ........ r54695 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-05 11:00:03 -0700 (Thu, 05 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Bug #1563759: struct.unpack doens't support buffer protocol objects ........ r54697 | collin.winter | 2007-04-05 13:05:07 -0700 (Thu, 05 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_long_future to use unittest. ........ r54698 | collin.winter | 2007-04-05 13:08:56 -0700 (Thu, 05 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_normalization to use unittest. ........ r54699 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-04-05 18:11:58 -0700 (Thu, 05 Apr 2007) | 1 line Some grammar fixes ........ r54704 | collin.winter | 2007-04-06 12:27:40 -0700 (Fri, 06 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_stringprep to use unittest. ........ r54705 | collin.winter | 2007-04-06 12:32:32 -0700 (Fri, 06 Apr 2007) | 1 line Import cleanup in test_crypt. ........ r54706 | collin.winter | 2007-04-06 13:00:05 -0700 (Fri, 06 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_gc to use unittest. ........ r54707 | collin.winter | 2007-04-06 13:03:11 -0700 (Fri, 06 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_module to use unittest. ........ r54711 | collin.winter | 2007-04-06 21:40:43 -0700 (Fri, 06 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_fileinput to use unittest. ........ r54712 | brett.cannon | 2007-04-07 21:29:32 -0700 (Sat, 07 Apr 2007) | 5 lines Doc that file.next() has undefined behaviour when called on a file opened with 'w'. Closes bug #1569057. To be backported once 2.5 branch is unfrozen. ........ r54726 | vinay.sajip | 2007-04-09 09:16:10 -0700 (Mon, 09 Apr 2007) | 1 line Added optional timeout to SocketHandler.makeSocket (SF #1695948) ........ r54727 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-04-09 12:10:29 -0700 (Mon, 09 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Patch #1695862: remove old test directory that causes test_urllib failures on Windows buildbots. The change is a one time fix and will be removed after a successful buildbot run. ........ r54729 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-09 20:00:37 -0700 (Mon, 09 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Minor fix to the tests pass ok even with -O. ........ r54730 | collin.winter | 2007-04-09 21:44:49 -0700 (Mon, 09 Apr 2007) | 1 line Typo fix. ........ r54732 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-10 05:58:45 -0700 (Tue, 10 Apr 2007) | 5 lines General clean-up. Lot of margin corrections, comments, some typos. Exceptions now are raised in the new style. And a mockup class is now also new style. Thanks Santiago Pereson. ........ r54741 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-10 14:39:38 -0700 (Tue, 10 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Repair a duplicate label and some obsolete uses of \setindexsubitem. ........ r54746 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-04-11 06:39:00 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 1 line Add window.chgat() method, submitted via e-mail by Fabian Kreutz ........ r54747 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-04-11 06:42:25 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 1 line Point readers at the patch submission instructions ........ r54748 | andrew.kuchling | 2007-04-11 06:47:13 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 1 line Describe undocumented third argument to touchline() ........ r54757 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-11 10:16:24 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Add some missing NULL checks which trigger crashes on low-memory conditions. Found by Victor Stinner. Will backport when 2.5 branch is unfrozen. ........ r54760 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-11 11:40:58 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 1 line SF 1191699: Make slices picklable ........ r54762 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-11 12:25:11 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Exceptions are no longer old-style instances. Fix accordingly. ........ r54763 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-11 16:28:44 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Repair missing spaces after \UNIX. ........ r54772 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-11 21:10:00 -0700 (Wed, 11 Apr 2007) | 1 line SF 1193128: Let str.translate(None) be an identity transformation ........ r54784 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-12 00:01:19 -0700 (Thu, 12 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1698951: clarify deprecation message in rexec and Bastion ........ r54785 | ziga.seilnacht | 2007-04-12 01:46:51 -0700 (Thu, 12 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1695862: remove the cleanup code, now that Windows buildbots are green again. ........ r54786 | walter.doerwald | 2007-04-12 03:35:00 -0700 (Thu, 12 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Fix utf-8-sig incremental decoder, which didn't recognise a BOM when the first chunk fed to the decoder started with a BOM, but was longer than 3 bytes. ........ r54807 | barry.warsaw | 2007-04-13 11:47:14 -0700 (Fri, 13 Apr 2007) | 8 lines Port r54805 from python25-maint branch: Add code to read from master_fd in the parent, breaking when we get an OSError (EIO can occur on Linux) or there's no more data to read. Without this, test_pty.py can hang on the waitpid() because the child is blocking on the stdout write. This will definitely happen on Mac OS X and could potentially happen on other platforms. See the comment for details. ........ r54812 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-13 15:07:33 -0700 (Fri, 13 Apr 2007) | 1 line Fix a bug when using the __lltrace__ opcode tracer, and a problem sith signed chars in frameobject.c which can occur with opcodes > 127 ........ r54814 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-13 15:20:13 -0700 (Fri, 13 Apr 2007) | 1 line Fix potential crash in path manipulation on windows ........ r54816 | trent.mick | 2007-04-13 16:22:05 -0700 (Fri, 13 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Add the necessary dependency for the Windows VC6 build to ensure 'pythoncore' is built before '_ctypes' is attempted. Will backport to 2.5 once it is unfrozen for 2.5.1. ........ r54825 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-13 22:25:50 -0700 (Fri, 13 Apr 2007) | 3 lines When __slots__ are set to a unicode string, make it work the same as setting a plain string, ie don't expand to single letter identifiers. ........ r54841 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-16 00:37:55 -0700 (Mon, 16 Apr 2007) | 1 line SF #1701207, Fix bogus assertion (and test it!) ........ r54844 | collin.winter | 2007-04-16 15:10:32 -0700 (Mon, 16 Apr 2007) | 1 line Check the availability of the urlfetch resource earlier than before. ........ r54849 | martin.v.loewis | 2007-04-16 22:02:01 -0700 (Mon, 16 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Add Travis Oliphant. ........ r54873 | brett.cannon | 2007-04-18 20:44:17 -0700 (Wed, 18 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Silence a compiler warning about incompatible pointer types. ........ r54874 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-18 22:52:37 -0700 (Wed, 18 Apr 2007) | 2 lines SF #1703270, add missing declaration in readline.c to avoid compiler warning. ........ r54875 | armin.rigo | 2007-04-19 07:44:48 -0700 (Thu, 19 Apr 2007) | 8 lines Revert r53997 as per http://mail.python.org/pipermail/python-dev/2007-March/071796.html . I've kept a couple of still-valid extra tests in test_descr, but didn't bother to sort through the new comments and refactorings added in r53997 to see if some of them could be kept. If so, they could go in a follow-up check-in. ........ r54876 | armin.rigo | 2007-04-19 07:56:48 -0700 (Thu, 19 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Fix a usage of the dangerous pattern decref - modify field - incref. ........ r54884 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-19 22:20:38 -0700 (Thu, 19 Apr 2007) | 9 lines Add an optional address to copy the failure mails to. Detect a conflict in the only file that should have outstanding changes when this script is run. This doesn't matter on the trunk, but does when run on a branch. Trunk always has the date set to today in boilerplate.tex. Each time a release is cut with a different date, a conflict occurs. (We could copy a known good version, but then we would lose changes to this file.) ........ r54918 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-21 13:35:38 -0700 (Sat, 21 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Bug #1704790: bind name "sys" locally in __del__ method so that it is not cleared before __del__ is run. ........ r54920 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-21 18:18:56 -0700 (Sat, 21 Apr 2007) | 5 lines Added tests for other methods of SSL object. Now we cover all the object methods. This is the final step to close the #451607 bug. ........ r54927 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-23 10:08:31 -0700 (Mon, 23 Apr 2007) | 5 lines As specified in RFC 2616, 2xx code indicates that the client's request was successfully received, understood, and accepted. Now in these cases no error is raised. Also fixed tests. ........ r54929 | collin.winter | 2007-04-23 20:43:46 -0700 (Mon, 23 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert PyUnit -> unittest. ........ r54931 | collin.winter | 2007-04-23 21:09:52 -0700 (Mon, 23 Apr 2007) | 1 line Remove code that hasn't been called in years. ........ r54932 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-23 21:53:12 -0700 (Mon, 23 Apr 2007) | 1 line Fix SF #1703110, Incorrect example for add_password() (use uri, not host) ........ r54934 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-24 03:36:42 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Some new year updates. ........ r54938 | facundo.batista | 2007-04-24 06:54:38 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Added a comment about last change in urllib2.py (all 2xx responses are ok now). ........ r54939 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-24 08:10:09 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Bug #1705717: error in sys.argv docs. ........ r54941 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-24 08:27:13 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 4 lines Bug #1706381: Specifying the SWIG option "-c++" in the setup.py file (as opposed to the command line) will now write file names ending in ".cpp" too. ........ r54944 | raymond.hettinger | 2007-04-24 15:13:43 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 1 line Fix markup ........ r54945 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-24 17:10:50 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 1 line Merge change 54909 from release25-maint: Fix several minor issues discovered using code analysis in VisualStudio 2005 Team Edition ........ r54947 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-24 17:17:39 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 1 line Make pythoncore compile cleanly with VisualStudio 2005. Used an explicit typecast to get a 64 bit integer, and undefined the Yield macro that conflicts with winbase.h ........ r54948 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-24 17:19:26 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 1 line Remove obsolete comment. Importing of .dll files has been discontinued, only .pyd files supported on windows now. ........ r54949 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-24 23:24:59 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Patch #1698768: updated the "using Python on the Mac" intro. ........ r54951 | georg.brandl | 2007-04-24 23:25:55 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Markup fix. ........ r54953 | neal.norwitz | 2007-04-24 23:30:05 -0700 (Tue, 24 Apr 2007) | 3 lines Whitespace normalization. Ugh, we really need to do this more often. You might want to review this change as it's my first time. Be gentle. :-) ........ r54956 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 10:29:52 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Standardize on test.test_support.run_unittest() (as opposed to a mix of run_unittest() and run_suite()). Also, add functionality to run_unittest() that admits usage of unittest.TestLoader.loadTestsFromModule(). ........ r54957 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 10:37:35 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Remove functionality from test_datetime.test_main() that does reference count checking; 'regrtest.py -R' is the way to do this kind of testing. ........ r54958 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 10:57:53 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Change test_support.have_unicode to use True/False instead of 1/0. ........ r54959 | tim.peters | 2007-04-25 11:47:18 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Whitespace normalization. ........ r54960 | tim.peters | 2007-04-25 11:48:35 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 2 lines Set missing svn:eol-style property on text files. ........ r54961 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 11:54:36 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Import and raise statement cleanup. ........ r54969 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 13:41:34 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Convert test_ossaudiodev to use unittest. ........ r54974 | collin.winter | 2007-04-25 14:50:25 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line Fix an issue related to the unittest conversion. ........ r54979 | fred.drake | 2007-04-25 21:42:19 -0700 (Wed, 25 Apr 2007) | 1 line fix some markup errors ........ r54982 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-26 02:15:08 -0700 (Thu, 26 Apr 2007) | 1 line Export function sanitize_the_mode from fileobject.c as _PyFile_SanitizeMode(). Use this function in posixmodule.c when implementing fdopen(). This fixes test_subprocess.py for a VisualStudio 2005 compile. ........ r54983 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-26 06:44:16 -0700 (Thu, 26 Apr 2007) | 1 line The locale "En" appears not to be valid on windows underi VisualStudio.2005. Added "English" to the test_locale.py to make the testsuite pass for that build ........ r54984 | steve.holden | 2007-04-26 07:23:12 -0700 (Thu, 26 Apr 2007) | 1 line Minor wording change on slicing aide-memoire. ........ r54985 | kristjan.jonsson | 2007-04-26 08:24:54 -0700 (Thu, 26 Apr 2007) | 1 line Accomodate 64 bit time_t in the _bsddb module. ........
This commit is contained in:
parent
6247fdbf93
commit
d8faa3654c
|
@ -4,6 +4,19 @@ import _ast
|
|||
import cStringIO
|
||||
import os
|
||||
|
||||
def interleave(inter, f, seq):
|
||||
"""Call f on each item in seq, calling inter() in between.
|
||||
"""
|
||||
seq = iter(seq)
|
||||
try:
|
||||
f(seq.next())
|
||||
except StopIteration:
|
||||
pass
|
||||
else:
|
||||
for x in seq:
|
||||
inter()
|
||||
f(x)
|
||||
|
||||
class Unparser:
|
||||
"""Methods in this class recursively traverse an AST and
|
||||
output source code for the abstract syntax; original formatting
|
||||
|
@ -63,26 +76,13 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
|
||||
def _Import(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("import ")
|
||||
first = True
|
||||
for a in t.names:
|
||||
if first:
|
||||
first = False
|
||||
else:
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
self.write(a.name)
|
||||
if a.asname:
|
||||
self.write(" as "+a.asname)
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), self.dispatch, t.names)
|
||||
|
||||
def _ImportFrom(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("from ")
|
||||
self.write(t.module)
|
||||
self.write(" import ")
|
||||
for i, a in enumerate(t.names):
|
||||
if i == 0:
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
self.write(a.name)
|
||||
if a.asname:
|
||||
self.write(" as "+a.asname)
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), self.dispatch, t.names)
|
||||
# XXX(jpe) what is level for?
|
||||
|
||||
def _Assign(self, t):
|
||||
|
@ -99,8 +99,9 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.dispatch(t.value)
|
||||
|
||||
def _Return(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("return ")
|
||||
self.fill("return")
|
||||
if t.value:
|
||||
self.write(" ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.value)
|
||||
|
||||
def _Pass(self, t):
|
||||
|
@ -138,18 +139,16 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.write(",")
|
||||
|
||||
def _Global(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("global")
|
||||
for i, n in enumerate(t.names):
|
||||
if i != 0:
|
||||
self.write(",")
|
||||
self.write(" " + n)
|
||||
self.fill("global ")
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), self.write, t.names)
|
||||
|
||||
def _Yield(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("yield")
|
||||
self.write("(")
|
||||
self.write("yield")
|
||||
if t.value:
|
||||
self.write(" (")
|
||||
self.write(" ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.value)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
def _Raise(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill('raise ')
|
||||
|
@ -188,8 +187,9 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.leave()
|
||||
|
||||
def _excepthandler(self, t):
|
||||
self.fill("except ")
|
||||
self.fill("except")
|
||||
if t.type:
|
||||
self.write(" ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.type)
|
||||
if t.name:
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
|
@ -289,9 +289,7 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
|
||||
def _List(self, t):
|
||||
self.write("[")
|
||||
for e in t.elts:
|
||||
self.dispatch(e)
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), self.dispatch, t.elts)
|
||||
self.write("]")
|
||||
|
||||
def _ListComp(self, t):
|
||||
|
@ -318,30 +316,31 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.dispatch(if_clause)
|
||||
|
||||
def _IfExp(self, t):
|
||||
self.write("(")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.body)
|
||||
self.write(" if ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.test)
|
||||
if t.orelse:
|
||||
self.write(" else ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.orelse)
|
||||
self.write(" else ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.orelse)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
def _Dict(self, t):
|
||||
self.write("{")
|
||||
for k,v in zip(t.keys, t.values):
|
||||
def writem((k, v)):
|
||||
self.dispatch(k)
|
||||
self.write(" : ")
|
||||
self.write(": ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(v)
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), writem, zip(t.keys, t.values))
|
||||
self.write("}")
|
||||
|
||||
def _Tuple(self, t):
|
||||
if not t.elts:
|
||||
self.write("()")
|
||||
return
|
||||
self.write("(")
|
||||
for e in t.elts:
|
||||
self.dispatch(e)
|
||||
self.write(", ")
|
||||
if len(t.elts) == 1:
|
||||
(elt,) = t.elts
|
||||
self.dispatch(elt)
|
||||
self.write(",")
|
||||
else:
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(", "), self.dispatch, t.elts)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
unop = {"Invert":"~", "Not": "not", "UAdd":"+", "USub":"-"}
|
||||
|
@ -357,7 +356,7 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
def _BinOp(self, t):
|
||||
self.write("(")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.left)
|
||||
self.write(")" + self.binop[t.op.__class__.__name__] + "(")
|
||||
self.write(" " + self.binop[t.op.__class__.__name__] + " ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.right)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -367,17 +366,15 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.write("(")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.left)
|
||||
for o, e in zip(t.ops, t.comparators):
|
||||
self.write(") " +self.cmpops[o.__class__.__name__] + " (")
|
||||
self.write(" " + self.cmpops[o.__class__.__name__] + " ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(e)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
boolops = {_ast.And: 'and', _ast.Or: 'or'}
|
||||
def _BoolOp(self, t):
|
||||
self.write("(")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.values[0])
|
||||
for v in t.values[1:]:
|
||||
self.write(" %s " % self.boolops[t.op.__class__])
|
||||
self.dispatch(v)
|
||||
s = " %s " % self.boolops[t.op.__class__]
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(s), self.dispatch, t.values)
|
||||
self.write(")")
|
||||
|
||||
def _Attribute(self,t):
|
||||
|
@ -433,10 +430,7 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.dispatch(t.step)
|
||||
|
||||
def _ExtSlice(self, t):
|
||||
for i, d in enumerate(t.dims):
|
||||
if i != 0:
|
||||
self.write(': ')
|
||||
self.dispatch(d)
|
||||
interleave(lambda: self.write(', '), self.dispatch, t.dims)
|
||||
|
||||
# others
|
||||
def _arguments(self, t):
|
||||
|
@ -472,9 +466,14 @@ class Unparser:
|
|||
self.write(": ")
|
||||
self.dispatch(t.body)
|
||||
|
||||
def _alias(self, t):
|
||||
self.write(t.name)
|
||||
if t.asname:
|
||||
self.write(" as "+t.asname)
|
||||
|
||||
def roundtrip(filename, output=sys.stdout):
|
||||
source = open(filename).read()
|
||||
tree = compile(source, filename, "exec", 0x400)
|
||||
tree = compile(source, filename, "exec", _ast.PyCF_ONLY_AST)
|
||||
Unparser(tree, output)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -790,7 +790,7 @@ determination.
|
|||
the Python statement \samp{del \var{o}[\var{i1}:\var{i2}]}.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PySequence_Count}{PyObject *o, PyObject *value}
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{Py_ssize_t}{PySequence_Count}{PyObject *o, PyObject *value}
|
||||
Return the number of occurrences of \var{value} in \var{o}, that is,
|
||||
return the number of keys for which \code{\var{o}[\var{key}] ==
|
||||
\var{value}}. On failure, return \code{-1}. This is equivalent to
|
||||
|
@ -804,7 +804,7 @@ determination.
|
|||
expression \samp{\var{value} in \var{o}}.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PySequence_Index}{PyObject *o, PyObject *value}
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{Py_ssize_t}{PySequence_Index}{PyObject *o, PyObject *value}
|
||||
Return the first index \var{i} for which \code{\var{o}[\var{i}] ==
|
||||
\var{value}}. On error, return \code{-1}. This is equivalent to
|
||||
the Python expression \samp{\var{o}.index(\var{value})}.
|
||||
|
@ -854,7 +854,7 @@ determination.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PySequence_Fast_GET_SIZE}{PyObject *o}
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{Py_ssize_t}{PySequence_Fast_GET_SIZE}{PyObject *o}
|
||||
Returns the length of \var{o}, assuming that \var{o} was
|
||||
returned by \cfunction{PySequence_Fast()} and that \var{o} is
|
||||
not \NULL. The size can also be gotten by calling
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -442,7 +442,9 @@ booleans. The following macros are available, however.
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{double}{PyFloat_AsDouble}{PyObject *pyfloat}
|
||||
Return a C \ctype{double} representation of the contents of
|
||||
\var{pyfloat}.
|
||||
\var{pyfloat}. If \var{pyfloat} is not a Python floating point
|
||||
object but has a \method{__float__} method, this method will first
|
||||
be called to convert \var{pyfloat} into a float.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{double}{PyFloat_AS_DOUBLE}{PyObject *pyfloat}
|
||||
|
@ -557,8 +559,11 @@ typedef struct {
|
|||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{Py_complex}{PyComplex_AsCComplex}{PyObject *op}
|
||||
Return the \ctype{Py_complex} value of the complex number
|
||||
\var{op}.
|
||||
Return the \ctype{Py_complex} value of the complex number \var{op}.
|
||||
\versionchanged[If \var{op} is not a Python complex number object
|
||||
but has a \method{__complex__} method, this method
|
||||
will first be called to convert \var{op} to a Python
|
||||
complex number object]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -2156,6 +2161,35 @@ def PyDict_MergeFromSeq2(a, seq2, override):
|
|||
|
||||
\section{Other Objects \label{otherObjects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Class Objects \label{classObjects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\obindex{class}
|
||||
Note that the class objects described here represent old-style classes,
|
||||
which will go away in Python 3. When creating new types for extension
|
||||
modules, you will want to work with type objects (section
|
||||
\ref{typeObjects}).
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{ctypedesc}{PyClassObject}
|
||||
The C structure of the objects used to describe built-in classes.
|
||||
\end{ctypedesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cvardesc}{PyObject*}{PyClass_Type}
|
||||
This is the type object for class objects; it is the same object as
|
||||
\code{types.ClassType} in the Python layer.
|
||||
\withsubitem{(in module types)}{\ttindex{ClassType}}
|
||||
\end{cvardesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PyClass_Check}{PyObject *o}
|
||||
Return true if the object \var{o} is a class object, including
|
||||
instances of types derived from the standard class object. Return
|
||||
false in all other cases.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PyClass_IsSubclass}{PyObject *klass, PyObject *base}
|
||||
Return true if \var{klass} is a subclass of \var{base}. Return false in
|
||||
all other cases.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{File Objects \label{fileObjects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\obindex{file}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -245,7 +245,7 @@
|
|||
program name (set by \cfunction{Py_SetProgramName()} above) and some
|
||||
environment variables. The returned string consists of a series of
|
||||
directory names separated by a platform dependent delimiter
|
||||
character. The delimiter character is \character{:} on \UNIX and Mac OS X,
|
||||
character. The delimiter character is \character{:} on \UNIX{} and Mac OS X,
|
||||
\character{;} on Windows. The returned string points into
|
||||
static storage; the caller should not modify its value. The value
|
||||
is available to Python code as the list
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -100,7 +100,9 @@ are available for allocating and releasing memory from the Python heap:
|
|||
memory block is resized but is not freed, and the returned pointer
|
||||
is non-\NULL. Unless \var{p} is \NULL, it must have been
|
||||
returned by a previous call to \cfunction{PyMem_Malloc()} or
|
||||
\cfunction{PyMem_Realloc()}.
|
||||
\cfunction{PyMem_Realloc()}. If the request fails,
|
||||
\cfunction{PyMem_Realloc()} returns \NULL{} and \var{p} remains a
|
||||
valid pointer to the previous memory area.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{void}{PyMem_Free}{void *p}
|
||||
|
@ -124,7 +126,8 @@ that \var{TYPE} refers to any C type.
|
|||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{\var{TYPE}*}{PyMem_Resize}{void *p, TYPE, size_t n}
|
||||
Same as \cfunction{PyMem_Realloc()}, but the memory block is resized
|
||||
to \code{(\var{n} * sizeof(\var{TYPE}))} bytes. Returns a pointer
|
||||
cast to \ctype{\var{TYPE}*}.
|
||||
cast to \ctype{\var{TYPE}*}. On return, \var{p} will be a pointer to
|
||||
the new memory area, or \NULL{} in the event of failure.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{void}{PyMem_Del}{void *p}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1316,7 +1316,7 @@ PyObject *tp_alloc(PyTypeObject *self, Py_ssize_t nitems)
|
|||
|
||||
This field is inherited by static subtypes, but not by dynamic
|
||||
subtypes (subtypes created by a class statement); in the latter,
|
||||
this field is always set to \cfunction{PyType_GenericAlloc()}, to
|
||||
this field is always set to \cfunction{PyType_GenericAlloc}, to
|
||||
force a standard heap allocation strategy. That is also the
|
||||
recommended value for statically defined types.
|
||||
\end{cmemberdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -930,3 +930,94 @@ PyArg_ParseTuple(args, "O|O:ref", &object, &callback)
|
|||
If there is an error in the format string, the
|
||||
\exception{SystemError} exception is set and \NULL{} returned.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\section{String conversion and formatting \label{string-formatting}}
|
||||
|
||||
Functions for number conversion and formatted string output.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PyOS_snprintf}{char *str, size_t size,
|
||||
const char *format, \moreargs}
|
||||
Output not more than \var{size} bytes to \var{str} according to the format
|
||||
string \var{format} and the extra arguments. See the \UNIX{} man
|
||||
page \manpage{snprintf}{2}.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{int}{PyOS_vsnprintf}{char *str, size_t size,
|
||||
const char *format, va_list va}
|
||||
Output not more than \var{size} bytes to \var{str} according to the format
|
||||
string \var{format} and the variable argument list \var{va}. \UNIX{}
|
||||
man page \manpage{vsnprintf}{2}.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\cfunction{PyOS_snprintf} and \cfunction{PyOS_vsnprintf} wrap the
|
||||
Standard C library functions \cfunction{snprintf()} and
|
||||
\cfunction{vsnprintf()}. Their purpose is to guarantee consistent
|
||||
behavior in corner cases, which the Standard C functions do not.
|
||||
|
||||
The wrappers ensure that \var{str}[\var{size}-1] is always
|
||||
\character{\textbackslash0} upon return. They never write more than
|
||||
\var{size} bytes (including the trailing \character{\textbackslash0}
|
||||
into str. Both functions require that \code{\var{str} != NULL},
|
||||
\code{\var{size} > 0} and \code{\var{format} != NULL}.
|
||||
|
||||
If the platform doesn't have \cfunction{vsnprintf()} and the buffer
|
||||
size needed to avoid truncation exceeds \var{size} by more than 512
|
||||
bytes, Python aborts with a \var{Py_FatalError}.
|
||||
|
||||
The return value (\var{rv}) for these functions should be interpreted
|
||||
as follows:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{itemize}
|
||||
|
||||
\item When \code{0 <= \var{rv} < \var{size}}, the output conversion
|
||||
was successful and \var{rv} characters were written to \var{str}
|
||||
(excluding the trailing \character{\textbackslash0} byte at
|
||||
\var{str}[\var{rv}]).
|
||||
|
||||
\item When \code{\var{rv} >= \var{size}}, the output conversion was
|
||||
truncated and a buffer with \code{\var{rv} + 1} bytes would have
|
||||
been needed to succeed. \var{str}[\var{size}-1] is
|
||||
\character{\textbackslash0} in this case.
|
||||
|
||||
\item When \code{\var{rv} < 0}, ``something bad happened.''
|
||||
\var{str}[\var{size}-1] is \character{\textbackslash0} in this case
|
||||
too, but the rest of \var{str} is undefined. The exact cause of the
|
||||
error depends on the underlying platform.
|
||||
|
||||
\end{itemize}
|
||||
|
||||
The following functions provide locale-independent string to number
|
||||
conversions.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{double}{PyOS_ascii_strtod}{const char *nptr, char **endptr}
|
||||
Convert a string to a \ctype{double}. This function behaves like the
|
||||
Standard C function \cfunction{strtod()} does in the C locale. It does
|
||||
this without changing the current locale, since that would not be
|
||||
thread-safe.
|
||||
|
||||
\cfunction{PyOS_ascii_strtod} should typically be used for reading
|
||||
configuration files or other non-user input that should be locale
|
||||
independent. \versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
|
||||
See the \UNIX{} man page \manpage{strtod}{2} for details.
|
||||
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{char *}{PyOS_ascii_formatd}{char *buffer, size_t buf_len,
|
||||
const char *format, double d}
|
||||
Convert a \ctype{double} to a string using the \character{.} as the
|
||||
decimal separator. \var{format} is a \cfunction{printf()}-style format
|
||||
string specifying the number format. Allowed conversion characters are
|
||||
\character{e}, \character{E}, \character{f}, \character{F},
|
||||
\character{g} and \character{G}.
|
||||
|
||||
The return value is a pointer to \var{buffer} with the converted
|
||||
string or NULL if the conversion failed. \versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{cfuncdesc}{double}{PyOS_ascii_atof}{const char *nptr}
|
||||
Convert a string to a \ctype{double} in a locale-independent
|
||||
way. \versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
|
||||
See the \UNIX{} man page \manpage{atof}{2} for details.
|
||||
\end{cfuncdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
|||
Copyright \copyright{} 2001-2006 Python Software Foundation.
|
||||
Copyright \copyright{} 2001-2007 Python Software Foundation.
|
||||
All rights reserved.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright \copyright{} 2000 BeOpen.com.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -52,6 +52,7 @@ GPL-compatible; the table below summarizes the various releases.
|
|||
\linev{2.4.3}{2.4.2}{2006}{PSF}{yes}
|
||||
\linev{2.4.4}{2.4.3}{2006}{PSF}{yes}
|
||||
\linev{2.5}{2.4}{2006}{PSF}{yes}
|
||||
\linev{2.5.1}{2.5}{2007}{PSF}{yes}
|
||||
\end{tablev}
|
||||
|
||||
\note{GPL-compatible doesn't mean that we're distributing
|
||||
|
@ -82,7 +83,7 @@ license to reproduce, analyze, test, perform and/or display publicly,
|
|||
prepare derivative works, distribute, and otherwise use Python
|
||||
\version{} alone or in any derivative version, provided, however, that
|
||||
PSF's License Agreement and PSF's notice of copyright, i.e.,
|
||||
``Copyright \copyright{} 2001-2006 Python Software Foundation; All
|
||||
``Copyright \copyright{} 2001-2007 Python Software Foundation; All
|
||||
Rights Reserved'' are retained in Python \version{} alone or in any
|
||||
derivative version prepared by Licensee.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1802,9 +1802,9 @@ example:
|
|||
setup.py
|
||||
foo.py
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
(In all diagrams in this section, \verb|<root>| will refer to the
|
||||
distribution root directory.) A minimal setup script to describe this
|
||||
situation would be:
|
||||
(In all diagrams in this section, \var{\textless root\textgreater}
|
||||
will refer to the distribution root directory.) A minimal setup script
|
||||
to describe this situation would be:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
from distutils.core import setup
|
||||
setup(name='foo',
|
||||
|
@ -3179,7 +3179,7 @@ for any variables not found in either \var{local_vars} or \code{os.environ}.
|
|||
|
||||
Note that this is not a fully-fledged string interpolation function. A
|
||||
valid \code{\$variable} can consist only of upper and lower case letters,
|
||||
numbers and an underscore. No \{ \} or \( \) style quoting is available.
|
||||
numbers and an underscore. No \{ \} or ( ) style quoting is available.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{grok_environment_error}{exc\optional{, prefix=\samp{'error: '}}}
|
||||
|
@ -3733,7 +3733,7 @@ implementing the class \class{peel_banana}, a subclass of
|
|||
|
||||
Subclasses of \class{Command} must define the following methods.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{initialize_options()}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Command]{initialize_options()}
|
||||
Set default values for all the options that this command
|
||||
supports. Note that these defaults may be overridden by other
|
||||
commands, by the setup script, by config files, or by the
|
||||
|
@ -3742,7 +3742,7 @@ between options; generally, \method{initialize_options()} implementations
|
|||
are just a bunch of \samp{self.foo = None} assignments.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{finalize_options}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Command]{finalize_options}{}
|
||||
Set final values for all the options that this command supports.
|
||||
This is always called as late as possible, ie. after any option
|
||||
assignments from the command-line or from other commands have been
|
||||
|
@ -3751,7 +3751,7 @@ done. Thus, this is the place to to code option dependencies: if
|
|||
\var{bar} as long as \var{foo} still has the same value it was assigned in
|
||||
\method{initialize_options()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{run}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Command]{run}{}
|
||||
A command's raison d'etre: carry out the action it exists to
|
||||
perform, controlled by the options initialized in
|
||||
\method{initialize_options()}, customized by other commands, the setup
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -489,7 +489,6 @@ this?
|
|||
garbage collection, there are calls that can be made to ``untrack''
|
||||
the object from garbage collection, however, these calls are
|
||||
advanced and not covered here.}
|
||||
\item
|
||||
\end{itemize}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -930,6 +929,102 @@ That's pretty much it. If we had written custom \member{tp_alloc} or
|
|||
collection. Most extensions will use the versions automatically
|
||||
provided.
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Subclassing other types}
|
||||
|
||||
It is possible to create new extension types that are derived from existing
|
||||
types. It is easiest to inherit from the built in types, since an extension
|
||||
can easily use the \class{PyTypeObject} it needs. It can be difficult to
|
||||
share these \class{PyTypeObject} structures between extension modules.
|
||||
|
||||
In this example we will create a \class{Shoddy} type that inherits from
|
||||
the builtin \class{list} type. The new type will be completely compatible
|
||||
with regular lists, but will have an additional \method{increment()} method
|
||||
that increases an internal counter.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> import shoddy
|
||||
>>> s = shoddy.Shoddy(range(3))
|
||||
>>> s.extend(s)
|
||||
>>> print len(s)
|
||||
6
|
||||
>>> print s.increment()
|
||||
1
|
||||
>>> print s.increment()
|
||||
2
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
\verbatiminput{shoddy.c}
|
||||
|
||||
As you can see, the source code closely resembles the \class{Noddy} examples in previous
|
||||
sections. We will break down the main differences between them.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
PyListObject list;
|
||||
int state;
|
||||
} Shoddy;
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
The primary difference for derived type objects is that the base type's
|
||||
object structure must be the first value. The base type will already
|
||||
include the \cfunction{PyObject_HEAD} at the beginning of its structure.
|
||||
|
||||
When a Python object is a \class{Shoddy} instance, its \var{PyObject*} pointer
|
||||
can be safely cast to both \var{PyListObject*} and \var{Shoddy*}.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
static int
|
||||
Shoddy_init(Shoddy *self, PyObject *args, PyObject *kwds)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (PyList_Type.tp_init((PyObject *)self, args, kwds) < 0)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
self->state = 0;
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
In the \member{__init__} method for our type, we can see how to call through
|
||||
to the \member{__init__} method of the base type.
|
||||
|
||||
This pattern is important when writing a type with custom \member{new} and
|
||||
\member{dealloc} methods. The \member{new} method should not actually create the
|
||||
memory for the object with \member{tp_alloc}, that will be handled by
|
||||
the base class when calling its \member{tp_new}.
|
||||
|
||||
When filling out the \cfunction{PyTypeObject} for the \class{Shoddy} type,
|
||||
you see a slot for \cfunction{tp_base}. Due to cross platform compiler
|
||||
issues, you can't fill that field directly with the \cfunction{PyList_Type};
|
||||
it can be done later in the module's \cfunction{init} function.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
PyMODINIT_FUNC
|
||||
initshoddy(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
PyObject *m;
|
||||
|
||||
ShoddyType.tp_base = &PyList_Type;
|
||||
if (PyType_Ready(&ShoddyType) < 0)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
m = Py_InitModule3("shoddy", NULL, "Shoddy module");
|
||||
if (m == NULL)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
Py_INCREF(&ShoddyType);
|
||||
PyModule_AddObject(m, "Shoddy", (PyObject *) &ShoddyType);
|
||||
}
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
Before calling \cfunction{PyType_Ready}, the type structure must have the
|
||||
\member{tp_base} slot filled in. When we are deriving a new type, it is
|
||||
not necessary to fill out the \member{tp_alloc} slot with
|
||||
\cfunction{PyType_GenericNew} -- the allocate function from the base type
|
||||
will be inherited.
|
||||
|
||||
After that, calling \cfunction{PyType_Ready} and adding the type object
|
||||
to the module is the same as with the basic \class{Noddy} examples.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\section{Type Methods
|
||||
\label{dnt-type-methods}}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
|
|||
#include <Python.h>
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
PyListObject list;
|
||||
int state;
|
||||
} Shoddy;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
static PyObject *
|
||||
Shoddy_increment(Shoddy *self, PyObject *unused)
|
||||
{
|
||||
self->state++;
|
||||
return PyInt_FromLong(self->state);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
static PyMethodDef Shoddy_methods[] = {
|
||||
{"increment", (PyCFunction)Shoddy_increment, METH_NOARGS,
|
||||
PyDoc_STR("increment state counter")},
|
||||
{NULL, NULL},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
Shoddy_init(Shoddy *self, PyObject *args, PyObject *kwds)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (PyList_Type.tp_init((PyObject *)self, args, kwds) < 0)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
self->state = 0;
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
static PyTypeObject ShoddyType = {
|
||||
PyObject_HEAD_INIT(NULL)
|
||||
0, /* ob_size */
|
||||
"shoddy.Shoddy", /* tp_name */
|
||||
sizeof(Shoddy), /* tp_basicsize */
|
||||
0, /* tp_itemsize */
|
||||
0, /* tp_dealloc */
|
||||
0, /* tp_print */
|
||||
0, /* tp_getattr */
|
||||
0, /* tp_setattr */
|
||||
0, /* tp_compare */
|
||||
0, /* tp_repr */
|
||||
0, /* tp_as_number */
|
||||
0, /* tp_as_sequence */
|
||||
0, /* tp_as_mapping */
|
||||
0, /* tp_hash */
|
||||
0, /* tp_call */
|
||||
0, /* tp_str */
|
||||
0, /* tp_getattro */
|
||||
0, /* tp_setattro */
|
||||
0, /* tp_as_buffer */
|
||||
Py_TPFLAGS_DEFAULT |
|
||||
Py_TPFLAGS_BASETYPE, /* tp_flags */
|
||||
0, /* tp_doc */
|
||||
0, /* tp_traverse */
|
||||
0, /* tp_clear */
|
||||
0, /* tp_richcompare */
|
||||
0, /* tp_weaklistoffset */
|
||||
0, /* tp_iter */
|
||||
0, /* tp_iternext */
|
||||
Shoddy_methods, /* tp_methods */
|
||||
0, /* tp_members */
|
||||
0, /* tp_getset */
|
||||
0, /* tp_base */
|
||||
0, /* tp_dict */
|
||||
0, /* tp_descr_get */
|
||||
0, /* tp_descr_set */
|
||||
0, /* tp_dictoffset */
|
||||
(initproc)Shoddy_init, /* tp_init */
|
||||
0, /* tp_alloc */
|
||||
0, /* tp_new */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
PyMODINIT_FUNC
|
||||
initshoddy(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
PyObject *m;
|
||||
|
||||
ShoddyType.tp_base = &PyList_Type;
|
||||
if (PyType_Ready(&ShoddyType) < 0)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
m = Py_InitModule3("shoddy", NULL, "Shoddy module");
|
||||
if (m == NULL)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
Py_INCREF(&ShoddyType);
|
||||
PyModule_AddObject(m, "Shoddy", (PyObject *) &ShoddyType);
|
||||
}
|
|
@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ being installed is pure Python or contains extensions (``non-pure''):
|
|||
\filevar{prefix} and \filevar{exec-prefix} stand for the directories
|
||||
that Python is installed to, and where it finds its libraries at
|
||||
run-time. They are always the same under Windows, and very
|
||||
often the same under \UNIX and Mac OS X. You can find out what your Python
|
||||
often the same under \UNIX{} and Mac OS X. You can find out what your Python
|
||||
installation uses for \filevar{prefix} and \filevar{exec-prefix} by
|
||||
running Python in interactive mode and typing a few simple commands.
|
||||
Under \UNIX, just type \code{python} at the shell prompt. Under
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -103,8 +103,7 @@ Python. In the abstract syntax tree, each node represents a syntactic
|
|||
construct. The root of the tree is \class{Module} object.
|
||||
|
||||
The abstract syntax offers a higher level interface to parsed Python
|
||||
source code. The \ulink{\module{parser}}
|
||||
{http://www.python.org/doc/current/lib/module-parser.html}
|
||||
source code. The \refmodule{parser}
|
||||
module and the compiler written in C for the Python interpreter use a
|
||||
concrete syntax tree. The concrete syntax is tied closely to the
|
||||
grammar description used for the Python parser. Instead of a single
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
|||
% Copyright (C) 2001-2006 Python Software Foundation
|
||||
% Copyright (C) 2001-2007 Python Software Foundation
|
||||
% Author: barry@python.org (Barry Warsaw)
|
||||
|
||||
\section{\module{email} ---
|
||||
|
@ -239,7 +239,7 @@ Here are the differences between \module{email} version 2 and version 1:
|
|||
|
||||
The \module{email} package was originally prototyped as a separate
|
||||
library called
|
||||
\ulink{\module{mimelib}}{http://mimelib.sf.net/}.
|
||||
\ulink{\texttt{mimelib}}{http://mimelib.sf.net/}.
|
||||
Changes have been made so that
|
||||
method names are more consistent, and some methods or modules have
|
||||
either been added or removed. The semantics of some of the methods
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ however, some mailers don't follow that format as specified, so
|
|||
\code{"Mon, 20 Nov 1995 19:12:08 -0500"}. If it succeeds in parsing
|
||||
the date, \function{parsedate()} returns a 9-tuple that can be passed
|
||||
directly to \function{time.mktime()}; otherwise \code{None} will be
|
||||
returned. Note that fields 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
returned. Note that indexes 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
usable.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ offset is the opposite of the sign of the \code{time.timezone}
|
|||
variable for the same timezone; the latter variable follows the
|
||||
\POSIX{} standard while this module follows \rfc{2822}.}. If the input
|
||||
string has no timezone, the last element of the tuple returned is
|
||||
\code{None}. Note that fields 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
\code{None}. Note that indexes 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
usable.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -89,25 +89,24 @@ aa:1c:95:52:6a:fa/14(ff)/8e:ba:5b:8:11:1a
|
|||
%
|
||||
The following methods are defined for capability objects.
|
||||
|
||||
\setindexsubitem{(capability method)}
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{dir_list}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{dir_list}{}
|
||||
Returns a list of the names of the entries in an Amoeba directory.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{b_read}{offset, maxsize}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{b_read}{offset, maxsize}
|
||||
Reads (at most)
|
||||
\var{maxsize}
|
||||
bytes from a bullet file at offset
|
||||
\var{offset.}
|
||||
The data is returned as a string.
|
||||
EOF is reported as an empty string.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{b_size}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{b_size}{}
|
||||
Returns the size of a bullet file.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{dir_append}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{dir_append}{}
|
||||
\funcline{dir_delete}{}
|
||||
\funcline{dir_lookup}{}
|
||||
\funcline{dir_replace}{}
|
||||
|
@ -116,17 +115,17 @@ Like the corresponding
|
|||
functions, but with a path relative to the capability.
|
||||
(For paths beginning with a slash the capability is ignored, since this
|
||||
is the defined semantics for Amoeba.)
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{std_info}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{std_info}{}
|
||||
Returns the standard info string of the object.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{tod_gettime}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{tod_gettime}{}
|
||||
Returns the time (in seconds since the Epoch, in UCT, as for \POSIX) from
|
||||
a time server.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{tod_settime}{t}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[capability]{tod_settime}{t}
|
||||
Sets the time kept by a time server.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ service) is closed.
|
|||
\begin{funcdesc}{loop}{\optional{timeout\optional{, use_poll\optional{,
|
||||
map\optional{,count}}}}}
|
||||
Enter a polling loop that terminates after count passes or all open
|
||||
channels have been closed. All arguments are optional. The \var(count)
|
||||
channels have been closed. All arguments are optional. The \var{count}
|
||||
parameter defaults to None, resulting in the loop terminating only
|
||||
when all channels have been closed. The \var{timeout} argument sets the
|
||||
timeout parameter for the appropriate \function{select()} or
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,7 +2,6 @@
|
|||
Interface to Berkeley DB library}
|
||||
|
||||
\declaremodule{extension}{bsddb}
|
||||
\platform{Unix, Windows}
|
||||
\modulesynopsis{Interface to Berkeley DB database library}
|
||||
\sectionauthor{Skip Montanaro}{skip@mojam.com}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -46,10 +45,10 @@ portability, only the first two arguments should be used in most
|
|||
instances.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{hashopen}{filename\optional{, flag\optional{,
|
||||
mode\optional{, bsize\optional{,
|
||||
mode\optional{, pgsize\optional{,
|
||||
ffactor\optional{, nelem\optional{,
|
||||
cachesize\optional{, hash\optional{,
|
||||
lorder}}}}}}}}}
|
||||
cachesize\optional{, lorder\optional{,
|
||||
hflags}}}}}}}}}
|
||||
Open the hash format file named \var{filename}. Files never intended
|
||||
to be preserved on disk may be created by passing \code{None} as the
|
||||
\var{filename}. The optional
|
||||
|
@ -80,7 +79,7 @@ interpretation.
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{rnopen}{filename\optional{, flag\optional{, mode\optional{,
|
||||
rnflags\optional{, cachesize\optional{, pgsize\optional{, lorder\optional{,
|
||||
reclen\optional{, bval\optional{, bfname}}}}}}}}}}
|
||||
rlen\optional{, delim\optional{, source\optional{, pad}}}}}}}}}}}
|
||||
|
||||
Open a DB record format file named \var{filename}. Files never intended
|
||||
to be preserved on disk may be created by passing \code{None} as the
|
||||
|
@ -114,23 +113,23 @@ the same methods as dictionaries. In addition, they support
|
|||
the methods listed below.
|
||||
\versionchanged[Added dictionary methods]{2.3.1}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the underlying file. The object can no longer be accessed. Since
|
||||
there is no open \method{open} method for these objects, to open the file
|
||||
again a new \module{bsddb} module open function must be called.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{keys}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{keys}{}
|
||||
Return the list of keys contained in the DB file. The order of the list is
|
||||
unspecified and should not be relied on. In particular, the order of the
|
||||
list returned is different for different file formats.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{has_key}{key}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{has_key}{key}
|
||||
Return \code{1} if the DB file contains the argument as a key.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_location}{key}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{set_location}{key}
|
||||
Set the cursor to the item indicated by \var{key} and return a tuple
|
||||
containing the key and its value. For binary tree databases (opened
|
||||
using \function{btopen()}), if \var{key} does not actually exist in
|
||||
|
@ -140,32 +139,32 @@ and return that key and value. For other databases,
|
|||
database.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{first}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{first}{}
|
||||
Set the cursor to the first item in the DB file and return it. The order of
|
||||
keys in the file is unspecified, except in the case of B-Tree databases.
|
||||
This method raises \exception{bsddb.error} if the database is empty.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{next}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{next}{}
|
||||
Set the cursor to the next item in the DB file and return it. The order of
|
||||
keys in the file is unspecified, except in the case of B-Tree databases.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{previous}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{previous}{}
|
||||
Set the cursor to the previous item in the DB file and return it. The
|
||||
order of keys in the file is unspecified, except in the case of B-Tree
|
||||
databases. This is not supported on hashtable databases (those opened
|
||||
with \function{hashopen()}).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{last}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{last}{}
|
||||
Set the cursor to the last item in the DB file and return it. The
|
||||
order of keys in the file is unspecified. This is not supported on
|
||||
hashtable databases (those opened with \function{hashopen()}).
|
||||
This method raises \exception{bsddb.error} if the database is empty.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sync}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[bsddbobject]{sync}{}
|
||||
Synchronize the database on disk.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -155,37 +155,37 @@ the \var{raw} parameter is false. This is relevant only for the
|
|||
|
||||
\class{RawConfigParser} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{defaults}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{defaults}{}
|
||||
Return a dictionary containing the instance-wide defaults.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sections}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{sections}{}
|
||||
Return a list of the sections available; \code{DEFAULT} is not
|
||||
included in the list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{add_section}{section}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{add_section}{section}
|
||||
Add a section named \var{section} to the instance. If a section by
|
||||
the given name already exists, \exception{DuplicateSectionError} is
|
||||
raised.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{has_section}{section}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{has_section}{section}
|
||||
Indicates whether the named section is present in the
|
||||
configuration. The \code{DEFAULT} section is not acknowledged.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{options}{section}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{options}{section}
|
||||
Returns a list of options available in the specified \var{section}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{has_option}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{has_option}{section, option}
|
||||
If the given section exists, and contains the given option,
|
||||
return \constant{True}; otherwise return \constant{False}.
|
||||
\versionadded{1.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{filenames}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{read}{filenames}
|
||||
Attempt to read and parse a list of filenames, returning a list of filenames
|
||||
which were successfully parsed. If \var{filenames} is a string or
|
||||
Unicode string, it is treated as a single filename.
|
||||
|
@ -210,28 +210,28 @@ config.read(['site.cfg', os.path.expanduser('~/.myapp.cfg')])
|
|||
\versionchanged[Returns list of successfully parsed filenames]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readfp}{fp\optional{, filename}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{readfp}{fp\optional{, filename}}
|
||||
Read and parse configuration data from the file or file-like object in
|
||||
\var{fp} (only the \method{readline()} method is used). If
|
||||
\var{filename} is omitted and \var{fp} has a \member{name} attribute,
|
||||
that is used for \var{filename}; the default is \samp{<???>}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{get}{section, option}
|
||||
Get an \var{option} value for the named \var{section}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getint}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{getint}{section, option}
|
||||
A convenience method which coerces the \var{option} in the specified
|
||||
\var{section} to an integer.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getfloat}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{getfloat}{section, option}
|
||||
A convenience method which coerces the \var{option} in the specified
|
||||
\var{section} to a floating point number.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getboolean}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{getboolean}{section, option}
|
||||
A convenience method which coerces the \var{option} in the specified
|
||||
\var{section} to a Boolean value. Note that the accepted values
|
||||
for the option are \code{"1"}, \code{"yes"}, \code{"true"}, and \code{"on"},
|
||||
|
@ -241,12 +241,12 @@ string values are checked in a case-insensitive manner. Any other value will
|
|||
cause it to raise \exception{ValueError}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{items}{section}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{items}{section}
|
||||
Return a list of \code{(\var{name}, \var{value})} pairs for each
|
||||
option in the given \var{section}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set}{section, option, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{set}{section, option, value}
|
||||
If the given section exists, set the given option to the specified
|
||||
value; otherwise raise \exception{NoSectionError}. While it is
|
||||
possible to use \class{RawConfigParser} (or \class{ConfigParser} with
|
||||
|
@ -256,14 +256,14 @@ output to files) can only be achieved using string values.
|
|||
\versionadded{1.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write}{fileobject}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{write}{fileobject}
|
||||
Write a representation of the configuration to the specified file
|
||||
object. This representation can be parsed by a future \method{read()}
|
||||
call.
|
||||
\versionadded{1.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{remove_option}{section, option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{remove_option}{section, option}
|
||||
Remove the specified \var{option} from the specified \var{section}.
|
||||
If the section does not exist, raise \exception{NoSectionError}.
|
||||
If the option existed to be removed, return \constant{True};
|
||||
|
@ -271,13 +271,13 @@ otherwise return \constant{False}.
|
|||
\versionadded{1.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{remove_section}{section}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{remove_section}{section}
|
||||
Remove the specified \var{section} from the configuration.
|
||||
If the section in fact existed, return \code{True}.
|
||||
Otherwise return \code{False}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{optionxform}{option}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RawConfigParser]{optionxform}{option}
|
||||
Transforms the option name \var{option} as found in an input file or
|
||||
as passed in by client code to the form that should be used in the
|
||||
internal structures. The default implementation returns a lower-case
|
||||
|
@ -293,14 +293,14 @@ option names case sensitive.
|
|||
The \class{ConfigParser} class extends some methods of the
|
||||
\class{RawConfigParser} interface, adding some optional arguments.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get}{section, option\optional{, raw\optional{, vars}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[ConfigParser]{get}{section, option\optional{, raw\optional{, vars}}}
|
||||
Get an \var{option} value for the named \var{section}. All the
|
||||
\character{\%} interpolations are expanded in the return values, based
|
||||
on the defaults passed into the constructor, as well as the options
|
||||
\var{vars} provided, unless the \var{raw} argument is true.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{items}{section\optional{, raw\optional{, vars}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[ConfigParser]{items}{section\optional{, raw\optional{, vars}}}
|
||||
Return a list of \code{(\var{name}, \var{value})} pairs for each
|
||||
option in the given \var{section}. Optional arguments have the
|
||||
same meaning as for the \method{get()} method.
|
||||
|
@ -313,7 +313,7 @@ same meaning as for the \method{get()} method.
|
|||
The \class{SafeConfigParser} class implements the same extended
|
||||
interface as \class{ConfigParser}, with the following addition:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set}{section, option, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SafeConfigParser]{set}{section, option, value}
|
||||
If the given section exists, set the given option to the specified
|
||||
value; otherwise raise \exception{NoSectionError}. \var{value} must
|
||||
be a string (\class{str} or \class{unicode}); if not,
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ to a file for later analysis.
|
|||
context\optional{, format}}}}}
|
||||
This function causes the \module{cgitb} module to take over the
|
||||
interpreter's default handling for exceptions by setting the
|
||||
value of \code{\refmodule{sys}.excepthook}.
|
||||
value of \member{\refmodule{sys}.excepthook}.
|
||||
\withsubitem{(in module sys)}{\ttindex{excepthook()}}
|
||||
|
||||
The optional argument \var{display} defaults to \code{1} and can be set
|
||||
|
@ -61,7 +61,7 @@ to a file for later analysis.
|
|||
report it using \module{cgitb}. The optional \var{info} argument
|
||||
should be a 3-tuple containing an exception type, exception
|
||||
value, and traceback object, exactly like the tuple returned by
|
||||
\code{\refmodule{sys}.exc_info()}. If the \var{info} argument
|
||||
\function{\refmodule{sys}.exc_info()}. If the \var{info} argument
|
||||
is not supplied, the current exception is obtained from
|
||||
\code{\refmodule{sys}.exc_info()}.
|
||||
\function{\refmodule{sys}.exc_info()}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -5,7 +5,14 @@
|
|||
\modulesynopsis{Mathematical functions for complex numbers.}
|
||||
|
||||
This module is always available. It provides access to mathematical
|
||||
functions for complex numbers. The functions are:
|
||||
functions for complex numbers. The functions in this module accept
|
||||
integers, floating-point numbers or complex numbers as arguments.
|
||||
They will also accept any Python object that has either a
|
||||
\method{__complex__} or a \method{__float__} method: these methods are
|
||||
used to convert the object to a complex or floating-point number, respectively, and
|
||||
the function is then applied to the result of the conversion.
|
||||
|
||||
The functions are:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{acos}{x}
|
||||
Return the arc cosine of \var{x}.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ will default to \var{sys.stdin} and \var{sys.stdout}.
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{Cmd} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{cmdloop}{\optional{intro}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{cmdloop}{\optional{intro}}
|
||||
Repeatedly issue a prompt, accept input, parse an initial prefix off
|
||||
the received input, and dispatch to action methods, passing them the
|
||||
remainder of the line as argument.
|
||||
|
@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ commands with corresponding \method{help_*()} methods), and also lists
|
|||
any undocumented commands.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{onecmd}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{onecmd}{str}
|
||||
Interpret the argument as though it had been typed in response to the
|
||||
prompt. This may be overridden, but should not normally need to be;
|
||||
see the \method{precmd()} and \method{postcmd()} methods for useful
|
||||
|
@ -93,25 +93,25 @@ value of that method is returned, otherwise the return value from the
|
|||
\method{default()} method is returned.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{emptyline}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{emptyline}{}
|
||||
Method called when an empty line is entered in response to the prompt.
|
||||
If this method is not overridden, it repeats the last nonempty command
|
||||
entered.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{default}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{default}{line}
|
||||
Method called on an input line when the command prefix is not
|
||||
recognized. If this method is not overridden, it prints an
|
||||
error message and returns.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{completedefault}{text, line, begidx, endidx}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{completedefault}{text, line, begidx, endidx}
|
||||
Method called to complete an input line when no command-specific
|
||||
\method{complete_*()} method is available. By default, it returns an
|
||||
empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{precmd}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{precmd}{line}
|
||||
Hook method executed just before the command line \var{line} is
|
||||
interpreted, but after the input prompt is generated and issued. This
|
||||
method is a stub in \class{Cmd}; it exists to be overridden by
|
||||
|
@ -121,7 +121,7 @@ implementation may re-write the command or simply return \var{line}
|
|||
unchanged.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{postcmd}{stop, line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{postcmd}{stop, line}
|
||||
Hook method executed just after a command dispatch is finished. This
|
||||
method is a stub in \class{Cmd}; it exists to be overridden by
|
||||
subclasses. \var{line} is the command line which was executed, and
|
||||
|
@ -133,13 +133,13 @@ corresponds to \var{stop}; returning false will cause interpretation
|
|||
to continue.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{preloop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{preloop}{}
|
||||
Hook method executed once when \method{cmdloop()} is called. This
|
||||
method is a stub in \class{Cmd}; it exists to be overridden by
|
||||
subclasses.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{postloop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cmd]{postloop}{}
|
||||
Hook method executed once when \method{cmdloop()} is about to return.
|
||||
This method is a stub in \class{Cmd}; it exists to be overridden by
|
||||
subclasses.
|
||||
|
@ -147,42 +147,52 @@ subclasses.
|
|||
|
||||
Instances of \class{Cmd} subclasses have some public instance variables:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{prompt}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{prompt}
|
||||
The prompt issued to solicit input.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{identchars}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{identchars}
|
||||
The string of characters accepted for the command prefix.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{lastcmd}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{lastcmd}
|
||||
The last nonempty command prefix seen.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{intro}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{intro}
|
||||
A string to issue as an intro or banner. May be overridden by giving
|
||||
the \method{cmdloop()} method an argument.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{doc_header}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{doc_header}
|
||||
The header to issue if the help output has a section for documented
|
||||
commands.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{misc_header}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{misc_header}
|
||||
The header to issue if the help output has a section for miscellaneous
|
||||
help topics (that is, there are \method{help_*()} methods without
|
||||
corresponding \method{do_*()} methods).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{undoc_header}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{undoc_header}
|
||||
The header to issue if the help output has a section for undocumented
|
||||
commands (that is, there are \method{do_*()} methods without
|
||||
corresponding \method{help_*()} methods).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ruler}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{ruler}
|
||||
The character used to draw separator lines under the help-message
|
||||
headers. If empty, no ruler line is drawn. It defaults to
|
||||
\character{=}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cmd]{use_rawinput}
|
||||
A flag, defaulting to true. If true, \method{cmdloop()} uses
|
||||
\function{input()} to display a prompt and read the next command;
|
||||
if false, \method{sys.stdout.write()} and
|
||||
\method{sys.stdin.readline()} are used. (This means that by
|
||||
importing \refmodule{readline}, on systems that support it, the
|
||||
interpreter will automatically support \program{Emacs}-like line editing
|
||||
and command-history keystrokes.)
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ syntax error, or raises \exception{OverflowError} or
|
|||
\subsection{Interactive Interpreter Objects
|
||||
\label{interpreter-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{runsource}{source\optional{, filename\optional{, symbol}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveInterpreter]{runsource}{source\optional{, filename\optional{, symbol}}}
|
||||
Compile and run some source in the interpreter.
|
||||
Arguments are the same as for \function{compile_command()}; the
|
||||
default for \var{filename} is \code{'<input>'}, and for
|
||||
|
@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ The return value can be used to decide whether to use
|
|||
\code{sys.ps1} or \code{sys.ps2} to prompt the next line.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{runcode}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveInterpreter]{runcode}{code}
|
||||
Execute a code object.
|
||||
When an exception occurs, \method{showtraceback()} is called to
|
||||
display a traceback. All exceptions are caught except
|
||||
|
@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ elsewhere in this code, and may not always be caught. The caller
|
|||
should be prepared to deal with it.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{showsyntaxerror}{\optional{filename}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveInterpreter]{showsyntaxerror}{\optional{filename}}
|
||||
Display the syntax error that just occurred. This does not display
|
||||
a stack trace because there isn't one for syntax errors.
|
||||
If \var{filename} is given, it is stuffed into the exception instead
|
||||
|
@ -118,13 +118,13 @@ always uses \code{'<string>'} when reading from a string.
|
|||
The output is written by the \method{write()} method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{showtraceback}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveInterpreter]{showtraceback}{}
|
||||
Display the exception that just occurred. We remove the first stack
|
||||
item because it is within the interpreter object implementation.
|
||||
The output is written by the \method{write()} method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write}{data}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveInterpreter]{write}{data}
|
||||
Write a string to the standard error stream (\code{sys.stderr}).
|
||||
Derived classes should override this to provide the appropriate output
|
||||
handling as needed.
|
||||
|
@ -138,7 +138,7 @@ The \class{InteractiveConsole} class is a subclass of
|
|||
\class{InteractiveInterpreter}, and so offers all the methods of the
|
||||
interpreter objects as well as the following additions.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{interact}{\optional{banner}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveConsole]{interact}{\optional{banner}}
|
||||
Closely emulate the interactive Python console.
|
||||
The optional banner argument specify the banner to print before the
|
||||
first interaction; by default it prints a banner similar to the one
|
||||
|
@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ name of the console object in parentheses (so as not to confuse this
|
|||
with the real interpreter -- since it's so close!).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{push}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveConsole]{push}{line}
|
||||
Push a line of source text to the interpreter.
|
||||
The line should not have a trailing newline; it may have internal
|
||||
newlines. The line is appended to a buffer and the interpreter's
|
||||
|
@ -160,11 +160,11 @@ appended. The return value is \code{True} if more input is required,
|
|||
\method{runsource()}).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{resetbuffer}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveConsole]{resetbuffer}{}
|
||||
Remove any unhandled source text from the input buffer.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{raw_input}{\optional{prompt}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[InteractiveConsole]{raw_input}{\optional{prompt}}
|
||||
Write a prompt and read a line. The returned line does not include
|
||||
the trailing newline. When the user enters the \EOF{} key sequence,
|
||||
\exception{EOFError} is raised. The base implementation reads from
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -307,7 +307,7 @@ The set of allowed values can be extended via \method{register_error}.
|
|||
The \class{Codec} class defines these methods which also define the
|
||||
function interfaces of the stateless encoder and decoder:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{encode}{input\optional{, errors}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Codec]{encode}{input\optional{, errors}}
|
||||
Encodes the object \var{input} and returns a tuple (output object,
|
||||
length consumed). While codecs are not restricted to use with Unicode, in
|
||||
a Unicode context, encoding converts a Unicode object to a plain string
|
||||
|
@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ function interfaces of the stateless encoder and decoder:
|
|||
empty object of the output object type in this situation.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{decode}{input\optional{, errors}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Codec]{decode}{input\optional{, errors}}
|
||||
Decodes the object \var{input} and returns a tuple (output object,
|
||||
length consumed). In a Unicode context, decoding converts a plain string
|
||||
encoded using a particular character set encoding to a Unicode object.
|
||||
|
@ -1233,9 +1233,8 @@ listed as operand type in the table.
|
|||
\lineiv{idna}
|
||||
{}
|
||||
{Unicode string}
|
||||
{Implements \rfc{3490}.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
See also \refmodule{encodings.idna}}
|
||||
{Implements \rfc{3490},
|
||||
see also \refmodule{encodings.idna}}
|
||||
|
||||
\lineiv{mbcs}
|
||||
{dbcs}
|
||||
|
@ -1250,8 +1249,7 @@ listed as operand type in the table.
|
|||
\lineiv{punycode}
|
||||
{}
|
||||
{Unicode string}
|
||||
{Implements \rfc{3492}.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}}
|
||||
{Implements \rfc{3492}}
|
||||
|
||||
\lineiv{quopri_codec}
|
||||
{quopri, quoted-printable, quotedprintable}
|
||||
|
@ -1305,6 +1303,8 @@ listed as operand type in the table.
|
|||
|
||||
\end{tableiv}
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded[The \code{idna} and \code{punycode} encodings]{2.3}
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{\module{encodings.idna} ---
|
||||
Internationalized Domain Names in Applications}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -9,14 +9,16 @@
|
|||
|
||||
|
||||
This module implements high-performance container datatypes. Currently,
|
||||
there are two datatypes, deque and defaultdict.
|
||||
there are two datatypes, deque and defaultdict, and one datatype factory
|
||||
function, \function{NamedTuple}.
|
||||
Future additions may include balanced trees and ordered dictionaries.
|
||||
\versionchanged[Added defaultdict]{2.5}
|
||||
\versionchanged[Added NamedTuple]{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{\class{deque} objects \label{deque-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{deque}{\optional{iterable}}
|
||||
Returns a new deque objected initialized left-to-right (using
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{deque}{\optional{iterable}}
|
||||
Returns a new deque object initialized left-to-right (using
|
||||
\method{append()}) with data from \var{iterable}. If \var{iterable}
|
||||
is not specified, the new deque is empty.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -30,7 +32,7 @@ Future additions may include balanced trees and ordered dictionaries.
|
|||
for \samp{pop(0)} and \samp{insert(0, v)} operations which change both the
|
||||
size and position of the underlying data representation.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
Deque objects support the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -219,7 +221,7 @@ def maketree(iterable):
|
|||
|
||||
\subsection{\class{defaultdict} objects \label{defaultdict-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{defaultdict}{\optional{default_factory\optional{, ...}}}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{defaultdict}{\optional{default_factory\optional{, ...}}}
|
||||
Returns a new dictionary-like object. \class{defaultdict} is a subclass
|
||||
of the builtin \class{dict} class. It overrides one method and adds one
|
||||
writable instance variable. The remaining functionality is the same as
|
||||
|
@ -231,7 +233,7 @@ def maketree(iterable):
|
|||
passed to the \class{dict} constructor, including keyword arguments.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\class{defaultdict} objects support the following method in addition to
|
||||
the standard \class{dict} operations:
|
||||
|
@ -254,11 +256,11 @@ the standard \class{dict} operations:
|
|||
|
||||
\class{defaultdict} objects support the following instance variable:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{default_factory}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{default_factory}
|
||||
This attribute is used by the \method{__missing__} method; it is initialized
|
||||
from the first argument to the constructor, if present, or to \code{None},
|
||||
if absent.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsubsection{\class{defaultdict} Examples \label{defaultdict-examples}}
|
||||
|
@ -339,3 +341,51 @@ Setting the \member{default_factory} to \class{set} makes the
|
|||
>>> d.items()
|
||||
[('blue', set([2, 4])), ('red', set([1, 3]))]
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{\function{NamedTuple} datatype factory function \label{named-tuple-factory}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{NamedTuple}{typename, fieldnames}
|
||||
Returns a new tuple subclass named \var{typename}. The new subclass is used
|
||||
to create tuple-like objects that have fields accessable by attribute
|
||||
lookup as well as being indexable and iterable. Instances of the subclass
|
||||
also have a helpful docstring (with typename and fieldnames) and a helpful
|
||||
\method{__repr__()} method which lists the tuple contents in a \code{name=value}
|
||||
format.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{fieldnames} are specified in a single string and are separated by spaces.
|
||||
Any valid Python identifier may be used for a field name.
|
||||
|
||||
Example:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> Point = NamedTuple('Point', 'x y')
|
||||
>>> Point.__doc__ # docstring for the new datatype
|
||||
'Point(x, y)'
|
||||
>>> p = Point(11, y=22) # instantiate with positional or keyword arguments
|
||||
>>> p[0] + p[1] # works just like the tuple (11, 22)
|
||||
33
|
||||
>>> x, y = p # unpacks just like a tuple
|
||||
>>> x, y
|
||||
(11, 22)
|
||||
>>> p.x + p.y # fields also accessable by name
|
||||
33
|
||||
>>> p # readable __repr__ with name=value style
|
||||
Point(x=11, y=22)
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
The use cases are the same as those for tuples. The named factories
|
||||
assign meaning to each tuple position and allow for more readable,
|
||||
self-documenting code. Named tuples can also be used to assign field names
|
||||
to tuples
|
||||
returned by the \module{csv} or \module{sqlite3} modules. For example:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
import csv
|
||||
EmployeeRecord = NamedTuple('EmployeeRecord', 'name age title department paygrade')
|
||||
for tup in csv.reader(open("employees.csv", "rb")):
|
||||
print EmployeeRecord(*tup)
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -39,6 +39,10 @@ and the return value is a string containing the command's output.
|
|||
Return the output of \samp{ls -ld \var{file}} as a string. This
|
||||
function uses the \function{getoutput()} function, and properly
|
||||
escapes backslashes and dollar signs in the argument.
|
||||
|
||||
\deprecated{2.6}{This function is nonobvious and useless,
|
||||
also the name is misleading in the presence of
|
||||
\function{getstatusoutput()}.}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
Example:
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ A small number of constants live in the built-in namespace. They are:
|
|||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{None}
|
||||
The sole value of \code{\refmodule{types}.NoneType}. \code{None} is
|
||||
The sole value of \member{\refmodule{types}.NoneType}. \code{None} is
|
||||
frequently used to represent the absence of a value, as when default
|
||||
arguments are not passed to a function.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -292,12 +292,12 @@ If there is a failure, the object's state will not be altered.
|
|||
|
||||
\class{FileCookieJar} instances have the following public attributes:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{filename}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[FileCookieJar]{filename}
|
||||
Filename of default file in which to keep cookies. This attribute may
|
||||
be assigned to.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{delayload}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[FileCookieJar]{delayload}
|
||||
If true, load cookies lazily from disk. This attribute should not be
|
||||
assigned to. This is only a hint, since this only affects
|
||||
performance, not behaviour (unless the cookies on disk are changing).
|
||||
|
@ -400,13 +400,13 @@ In addition to implementing the methods above, implementations of the
|
|||
attributes, indicating which protocols should be used, and how. All
|
||||
of these attributes may be assigned to.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{netscape}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[CookiePolicy]{netscape}
|
||||
Implement Netscape protocol.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{rfc2965}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[CookiePolicy]{rfc2965}
|
||||
Implement RFC 2965 protocol.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{hide_cookie2}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[CookiePolicy]{hide_cookie2}
|
||||
Don't add \mailheader{Cookie2} header to requests (the presence of
|
||||
this header indicates to the server that we understand RFC 2965
|
||||
cookies).
|
||||
|
@ -504,7 +504,7 @@ receiving cookies.
|
|||
which are all initialised from the constructor arguments of the same
|
||||
name, and which may all be assigned to.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{rfc2109_as_netscape}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{rfc2109_as_netscape}
|
||||
If true, request that the \class{CookieJar} instance downgrade RFC
|
||||
2109 cookies (ie. cookies received in a \mailheader{Set-Cookie} header
|
||||
with a version cookie-attribute of 1) to Netscape cookies by setting
|
||||
|
@ -517,7 +517,7 @@ RFC 2109 cookies are downgraded by default.
|
|||
|
||||
General strictness switches:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_domain}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_domain}
|
||||
Don't allow sites to set two-component domains with country-code
|
||||
top-level domains like \code{.co.uk}, \code{.gov.uk},
|
||||
\code{.co.nz}.etc. This is far from perfect and isn't guaranteed to
|
||||
|
@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ work!
|
|||
|
||||
RFC 2965 protocol strictness switches:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_rfc2965_unverifiable}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_rfc2965_unverifiable}
|
||||
Follow RFC 2965 rules on unverifiable transactions (usually, an
|
||||
unverifiable transaction is one resulting from a redirect or a request
|
||||
for an image hosted on another site). If this is false, cookies are
|
||||
|
@ -535,19 +535,19 @@ for an image hosted on another site). If this is false, cookies are
|
|||
|
||||
Netscape protocol strictness switches:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_ns_unverifiable}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_ns_unverifiable}
|
||||
apply RFC 2965 rules on unverifiable transactions even to Netscape
|
||||
cookies
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_ns_domain}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_ns_domain}
|
||||
Flags indicating how strict to be with domain-matching rules for
|
||||
Netscape cookies. See below for acceptable values.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_ns_set_initial_dollar}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_ns_set_initial_dollar}
|
||||
Ignore cookies in Set-Cookie: headers that have names starting with
|
||||
\code{'\$'}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{strict_ns_set_path}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{strict_ns_set_path}
|
||||
Don't allow setting cookies whose path doesn't path-match request URI.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -556,30 +556,30 @@ constructed by or-ing together (for example,
|
|||
\code{DomainStrictNoDots|DomainStrictNonDomain} means both flags are
|
||||
set).
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{DomainStrictNoDots}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{DomainStrictNoDots}
|
||||
When setting cookies, the 'host prefix' must not contain a dot
|
||||
(eg. \code{www.foo.bar.com} can't set a cookie for \code{.bar.com},
|
||||
because \code{www.foo} contains a dot).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{DomainStrictNonDomain}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{DomainStrictNonDomain}
|
||||
Cookies that did not explicitly specify a \code{domain}
|
||||
cookie-attribute can only be returned to a domain equal to the domain
|
||||
that set the cookie (eg. \code{spam.example.com} won't be returned
|
||||
cookies from \code{example.com} that had no \code{domain}
|
||||
cookie-attribute).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{DomainRFC2965Match}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{DomainRFC2965Match}
|
||||
When setting cookies, require a full RFC 2965 domain-match.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
The following attributes are provided for convenience, and are the
|
||||
most useful combinations of the above flags:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{DomainLiberal}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{DomainLiberal}
|
||||
Equivalent to 0 (ie. all of the above Netscape domain strictness flags
|
||||
switched off).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{DomainStrict}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[DefaultCookiePolicy]{DomainStrict}
|
||||
Equivalent to \code{DomainStrictNoDots|DomainStrictNonDomain}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -7,21 +7,21 @@
|
|||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
|
||||
\code{ctypes} is a foreign function library for Python. It provides C
|
||||
compatible data types, and allows to call functions in dlls/shared
|
||||
compatible data types, and allows calling functions in dlls/shared
|
||||
libraries. It can be used to wrap these libraries in pure Python.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{ctypes tutorial\label{ctypes-ctypes-tutorial}}
|
||||
|
||||
Note: The code samples in this tutorial uses \code{doctest} to make sure
|
||||
Note: The code samples in this tutorial use \code{doctest} to make sure
|
||||
that they actually work. Since some code samples behave differently
|
||||
under Linux, Windows, or Mac OS X, they contain doctest directives in
|
||||
comments.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: Quite some code samples references the ctypes \class{c{\_}int} type.
|
||||
Note: Some code sample references the ctypes \class{c{\_}int} type.
|
||||
This type is an alias to the \class{c{\_}long} type on 32-bit systems. So,
|
||||
you should not be confused if \class{c{\_}long} is printed if you would
|
||||
expect \class{c{\_}int} - they are actually the same type.
|
||||
expect \class{c{\_}int} --- they are actually the same type.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsubsection{Loading dynamic link libraries\label{ctypes-loading-dynamic-link-libraries}}
|
||||
|
@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ return a Windows \class{HRESULT} error code. The error code is used to
|
|||
automatically raise \class{WindowsError} Python exceptions when the
|
||||
function call fails.
|
||||
|
||||
Here are some examples for Windows, note that \code{msvcrt} is the MS
|
||||
Here are some examples for Windows. Note that \code{msvcrt} is the MS
|
||||
standard C library containing most standard C functions, and uses the
|
||||
cdecl calling convention:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
|
@ -1219,7 +1219,7 @@ py_cmp_func 5 7
|
|||
It is quite interesting to see that the Windows \function{qsort} function
|
||||
needs more comparisons than the linux version!
|
||||
|
||||
As we can easily check, our array sorted now:
|
||||
As we can easily check, our array is sorted now:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> for i in ia: print i,
|
||||
...
|
||||
|
@ -1242,7 +1242,7 @@ variables. An example in the Python library itself is the
|
|||
\programopt{-O} or \programopt{-OO} flag given on startup.
|
||||
|
||||
\code{ctypes} can access values like this with the \method{in{\_}dll} class
|
||||
methods of the type. \var{pythonapi} ìs a predefined symbol giving
|
||||
methods of the type. \var{pythonapi} is a predefined symbol giving
|
||||
access to the Python C api:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> opt_flag = c_int.in_dll(pythonapi, "Py_OptimizeFlag")
|
||||
|
@ -2113,7 +2113,7 @@ debugging; never modify the contents of this dictionary.
|
|||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsubsection{Fundamental data types\label{ctypes-fundamental-data-types}}
|
||||
\subsubsection{Fundamental data types\label{ctypes-fundamental-data-types-2}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{_SimpleCData}
|
||||
This non-public class is the base class of all fundamental ctypes
|
||||
|
@ -2294,6 +2294,13 @@ a zero-terminated wide character string. The constructor accepts
|
|||
an integer address, or a string.
|
||||
\end{classdesc*}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{c_bool}
|
||||
Represent the C \code{bool} datatype (more accurately, _Bool from C99).
|
||||
Its value can be True or False, and the constructor accepts any object that
|
||||
has a truth value.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{classdesc*}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{HRESULT}
|
||||
Windows only: Represents a \class{HRESULT} value, which contains success
|
||||
or error information for a function or method call.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -646,6 +646,16 @@ Similar to \method{border()}, but both \var{ls} and \var{rs} are
|
|||
corner characters are always used by this function.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[window]{chgat}{\optional{y, x, } \optional{num,} attr}
|
||||
Sets the attributes of \var{num} characters at the current cursor
|
||||
position, or at position \code{(\var{y}, \var{x})} if supplied. If no
|
||||
value of \var{num} is given or \var{num} = -1, the attribute will
|
||||
be set on all the characters to the end of the line.
|
||||
This function does not move the cursor. The changed line
|
||||
will be touched using the \method{touchline} method so that the
|
||||
contents will be redisplayed by the next window refresh.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[window]{clear}{}
|
||||
Like \method{erase()}, but also causes the whole window to be repainted
|
||||
upon next call to \method{refresh()}.
|
||||
|
@ -1014,9 +1024,11 @@ block for \var{delay} milliseconds, and return -1 if there is still no
|
|||
input at the end of that time.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[window]{touchline}{start, count}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[window]{touchline}{start, count\optional{, changed}}
|
||||
Pretend \var{count} lines have been changed, starting with line
|
||||
\var{start}.
|
||||
\var{start}. If \var{changed} is supplied, it specifies
|
||||
whether the affected lines are marked as
|
||||
having been changed (\var{changed}=1) or unchanged (\var{changed}=0).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[window]{touchwin}{}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -45,52 +45,52 @@ responsible for the window's depth in the panel stack.
|
|||
|
||||
Panel objects have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{above}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{above}{}
|
||||
Returns the panel above the current panel.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{below}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{below}{}
|
||||
Returns the panel below the current panel.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{bottom}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{bottom}{}
|
||||
Push the panel to the bottom of the stack.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{hidden}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{hidden}{}
|
||||
Returns true if the panel is hidden (not visible), false otherwise.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{hide}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{hide}{}
|
||||
Hide the panel. This does not delete the object, it just makes the
|
||||
window on screen invisible.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{move}{y, x}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{move}{y, x}
|
||||
Move the panel to the screen coordinates \code{(\var{y}, \var{x})}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{replace}{win}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{replace}{win}
|
||||
Change the window associated with the panel to the window \var{win}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_userptr}{obj}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{set_userptr}{obj}
|
||||
Set the panel's user pointer to \var{obj}. This is used to associate an
|
||||
arbitrary piece of data with the panel, and can be any Python object.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{show}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{show}{}
|
||||
Display the panel (which might have been hidden).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{top}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{top}{}
|
||||
Push panel to the top of the stack.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{userptr}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{userptr}{}
|
||||
Returns the user pointer for the panel. This might be any Python object.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{window}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Panel]{window}{}
|
||||
Returns the window object associated with the panel.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1154,7 +1154,7 @@ following methods. Exactly which methods are needed depends on the
|
|||
uses made of aware \module{datetime} objects. If in doubt, simply
|
||||
implement all of them.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{utcoffset}{self, dt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[tzinfo]{utcoffset}{self, dt}
|
||||
Return offset of local time from UTC, in minutes east of UTC. If
|
||||
local time is west of UTC, this should be negative. Note that this
|
||||
is intended to be the total offset from UTC; for example, if a
|
||||
|
@ -1178,7 +1178,7 @@ implement all of them.
|
|||
\exception{NotImplementedError}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{dst}{self, dt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[tzinfo]{dst}{self, dt}
|
||||
Return the daylight saving time (DST) adjustment, in minutes east of
|
||||
UTC, or \code{None} if DST information isn't known. Return
|
||||
\code{timedelta(0)} if DST is not in effect.
|
||||
|
@ -1237,7 +1237,7 @@ implement all of them.
|
|||
\exception{NotImplementedError}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{tzname}{self, dt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[tzinfo]{tzname}{self, dt}
|
||||
Return the time zone name corresponding to the \class{datetime}
|
||||
object \var{dt}, as a string.
|
||||
Nothing about string names is defined by the
|
||||
|
@ -1278,7 +1278,7 @@ and not need worry about objects in other timezones.
|
|||
There is one more \class{tzinfo} method that a subclass may wish to
|
||||
override:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{fromutc}{self, dt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[tzinfo]{fromutc}{self, dt}
|
||||
This is called from the default \class{datetime.astimezone()}
|
||||
implementation. When called from that, \code{\var{dt}.tzinfo} is
|
||||
\var{self}, and \var{dt}'s date and time members are to be viewed as
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,7 +2,6 @@
|
|||
DBM-style interface to the BSD database library}
|
||||
|
||||
\declaremodule{standard}{dbhash}
|
||||
\platform{Unix, Windows}
|
||||
\modulesynopsis{DBM-style interface to the BSD database library.}
|
||||
\sectionauthor{Fred L. Drake, Jr.}{fdrake@acm.org}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -425,7 +425,7 @@ also have a number of specialized methods:
|
|||
|
||||
|
||||
%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
|
||||
\subsection{Context objects \label{decimal-decimal}}
|
||||
\subsection{Context objects \label{decimal-context}}
|
||||
|
||||
Contexts are environments for arithmetic operations. They govern precision,
|
||||
set rules for rounding, determine which signals are treated as exceptions, and
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -67,11 +67,11 @@ example of the fact that using this module is usually a bad alternative.
|
|||
Dl objects, as returned by \function{open()} above, have the
|
||||
following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[dl]{close}{}
|
||||
Free all resources, except the memory.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sym}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[dl]{sym}{name}
|
||||
Return the pointer for the function named \var{name}, as a number, if
|
||||
it exists in the referenced shared object, otherwise \code{None}. This
|
||||
is useful in code like:
|
||||
|
@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ is useful in code like:
|
|||
\NULL{} pointer)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{call}{name\optional{, arg1\optional{, arg2\ldots}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[dl]{call}{name\optional{, arg1\optional{, arg2\ldots}}}
|
||||
Call the function named \var{name} in the referenced shared object.
|
||||
The arguments must be either Python integers, which will be
|
||||
passed as is, Python strings, to which a pointer will be passed,
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -201,6 +201,19 @@ prohibit it by passing \code{verbose=False}. In either of those cases,
|
|||
\code{sys.argv} is not examined by \function{testmod()} (so passing
|
||||
\programopt{-v} or not has no effect).
|
||||
|
||||
Since Python 2.6, there is also a command line shortcut for running
|
||||
\function{testmod()}. You can instruct the Python interpreter to run
|
||||
the doctest module directly from the standard library and pass the module
|
||||
name(s) on the command line:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
python -m doctest -v example.py
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
This will import \file{example.py} as a standalone module and run
|
||||
\function{testmod()} on it. Note that this may not work correctly if the
|
||||
file is part of a package and imports other submodules from that package.
|
||||
|
||||
For more information on \function{testmod()}, see
|
||||
section~\ref{doctest-basic-api}.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -267,6 +280,18 @@ Like \function{testmod()}, \function{testfile()}'s verbosity can be
|
|||
set with the \programopt{-v} command-line switch or with the optional
|
||||
keyword argument \var{verbose}.
|
||||
|
||||
Since Python 2.6, there is also a command line shortcut for running
|
||||
\function{testfile()}. You can instruct the Python interpreter to run
|
||||
the doctest module directly from the standard library and pass the file
|
||||
name(s) on the command line:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
python -m doctest -v example.txt
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
Because the file name does not end with \file{.py}, \module{doctest} infers
|
||||
that it must be run with \function{testfile()}, not \function{testmod()}.
|
||||
|
||||
For more information on \function{testfile()}, see
|
||||
section~\ref{doctest-basic-api}.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -1716,7 +1741,7 @@ Doctest provides several mechanisms for debugging doctest examples:
|
|||
>>>
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
\versionchanged[The ability to use \code{\refmodule{pdb}.set_trace()}
|
||||
\versionchanged[The ability to use \function{\refmodule{pdb}.set_trace()}
|
||||
usefully inside doctests was added]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{itemize}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -1800,10 +1825,10 @@ print doctest.testsource(a, "a.f")
|
|||
used. If \var{pm} has a true value, the script file is run directly, and
|
||||
the debugger gets involved only if the script terminates via raising an
|
||||
unhandled exception. If it does, then post-mortem debugging is invoked,
|
||||
via \code{\refmodule{pdb}.post_mortem()}, passing the traceback object
|
||||
via \function{\refmodule{pdb}.post_mortem()}, passing the traceback object
|
||||
from the unhandled exception. If \var{pm} is not specified, or is false,
|
||||
the script is run under the debugger from the start, via passing an
|
||||
appropriate \function{execfile()} call to \code{\refmodule{pdb}.run()}.
|
||||
appropriate \function{execfile()} call to \function{\refmodule{pdb}.run()}.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -14,8 +14,12 @@ HTTP GET requests. Servers can either be free standing, using
|
|||
\class{DocXMLRPCServer}, or embedded in a CGI environment, using
|
||||
\class{DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler}.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{DocXMLRPCServer}{addr\optional{,
|
||||
requestHandler\optional{, logRequests}}}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{DocXMLRPCServer}{addr\optional{,
|
||||
requestHandler\optional{,
|
||||
logRequests\optional{,
|
||||
allow_none\optional{,
|
||||
encoding\optional{,
|
||||
bind_and_activate}}}}}}
|
||||
|
||||
Create a new server instance. All parameters have the same meaning as
|
||||
for \class{SimpleXMLRPCServer.SimpleXMLRPCServer};
|
||||
|
@ -47,14 +51,14 @@ requests are handled as XML-RPC method calls. HTTP GET requests are
|
|||
handled by generating pydoc-style HTML documentation. This allows a
|
||||
server to provide its own web-based documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_title}{server_title}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocXMLRPCServer]{set_server_title}{server_title}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the title used in the generated HTML documentation. This title
|
||||
will be used inside the HTML "title" element.
|
||||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_name}{server_name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocXMLRPCServer]{set_server_name}{server_name}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the name used in the generated HTML documentation. This name will
|
||||
appear at the top of the generated documentation inside a "h1"
|
||||
|
@ -63,7 +67,7 @@ element.
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_documentation}{server_documentation}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocXMLRPCServer]{set_server_documentation}{server_documentation}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the description used in the generated HTML documentation. This
|
||||
description will appear as a paragraph, below the server name, in the
|
||||
|
@ -80,14 +84,14 @@ are handled as XML-RPC method calls. HTTP GET requests are handled by
|
|||
generating pydoc-style HTML documentation. This allows a server to
|
||||
provide its own web-based documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_title}{server_title}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{set_server_title}{server_title}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the title used in the generated HTML documentation. This title
|
||||
will be used inside the HTML "title" element.
|
||||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_name}{server_name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{set_server_name}{server_name}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the name used in the generated HTML documentation. This name will
|
||||
appear at the top of the generated documentation inside a "h1"
|
||||
|
@ -96,7 +100,7 @@ element.
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_server_documentation}{server_documentation}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{set_server_documentation}{server_documentation}
|
||||
|
||||
Set the description used in the generated HTML documentation. This
|
||||
description will appear as a paragraph, below the server name, in the
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ only when the database has to be created. It defaults to octal
|
|||
In addition to the methods provided by the \class{UserDict.DictMixin} class,
|
||||
\class{dumbdbm} objects provide the following methods.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sync}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[dumbdbm]{sync}{}
|
||||
Synchronize the on-disk directory and data files. This method is called by
|
||||
the \method{sync} method of \class{Shelve} objects.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -144,12 +144,12 @@ Returns a tuple containing an Element instance and a dictionary.
|
|||
Element objects returned by Element or SubElement have the
|
||||
following methods and attributes.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{tag}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Element]{tag}
|
||||
A string identifying what kind of data this element represents
|
||||
(the element type, in other words).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{text}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Element]{text}
|
||||
The \var{text} attribute can be used to hold additional data
|
||||
associated with the element.
|
||||
As the name implies this attribute is usually a string but may be any
|
||||
|
@ -158,7 +158,7 @@ If the element is created from an XML file the attribute will contain
|
|||
any text found between the element tags.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{tail}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Element]{tail}
|
||||
The \var{tail} attribute can be used to hold additional data
|
||||
associated with the element.
|
||||
This attribute is usually a string but may be any application-specific object.
|
||||
|
@ -166,7 +166,7 @@ If the element is created from an XML file the attribute will contain
|
|||
any text found after the element's end tag and before the next tag.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{attrib}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Element]{attrib}
|
||||
A dictionary containing the element's attributes.
|
||||
Note that while the \var{attrib} value is always a real mutable Python
|
||||
dictionary, an ElementTree implementation may choose to use another
|
||||
|
@ -177,52 +177,52 @@ dictionary methods below whenever possible.
|
|||
|
||||
The following dictionary-like methods work on the element attributes.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{clear}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{clear}{}
|
||||
Resets an element. This function removes all subelements, clears
|
||||
all attributes, and sets the text and tail attributes to None.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get}{key\optional{, default=None}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{get}{key\optional{, default=None}}
|
||||
Gets the element attribute named \var{key}.
|
||||
|
||||
Returns the attribute value, or \var{default} if the
|
||||
attribute was not found.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{items}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{items}{}
|
||||
Returns the element attributes as a sequence of (name, value) pairs.
|
||||
The attributes are returned in an arbitrary order.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{keys}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{keys}{}
|
||||
Returns the elements attribute names as a list.
|
||||
The names are returned in an arbitrary order.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set}{key, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{set}{key, value}
|
||||
Set the attribute \var{key} on the element to \var{value}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
The following methods work on the element's children (subelements).
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{append}{subelement}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{append}{subelement}
|
||||
Adds the element \var{subelement} to the end of this elements internal list
|
||||
of subelements.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{find}{match}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{find}{match}
|
||||
Finds the first subelement matching \var{match}.
|
||||
\var{match} may be a tag name or path.
|
||||
Returns an element instance or \code{None}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{findall}{match}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{findall}{match}
|
||||
Finds all subelements matching \var{match}.
|
||||
\var{match} may be a tag name or path.
|
||||
Returns an iterable yielding all matching elements in document order.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{findtext}{condition\optional{, default=None}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{findtext}{condition\optional{, default=None}}
|
||||
Finds text for the first subelement matching \var{condition}.
|
||||
\var{condition} may be a tag name or path.
|
||||
Returns the text content of the first matching element, or
|
||||
|
@ -230,11 +230,11 @@ Returns the text content of the first matching element, or
|
|||
matching element has no text content an empty string is returned.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getchildren}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{getchildren}{}
|
||||
Returns all subelements. The elements are returned in document order.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getiterator}{\optional{tag=None}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{getiterator}{\optional{tag=None}}
|
||||
Creates a tree iterator with the current element as the root.
|
||||
The iterator iterates over this element and all elements below it
|
||||
that match the given tag. If tag
|
||||
|
@ -243,16 +243,16 @@ Returns an iterable that provides element objects in document (depth first)
|
|||
order.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{insert}{index, element}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{insert}{index, element}
|
||||
Inserts a subelement at the given position in this element.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{makeelement}{tag, attrib}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{makeelement}{tag, attrib}
|
||||
Creates a new element object of the same type as this element.
|
||||
Do not call this method, use the SubElement factory function instead.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{remove}{subelement}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Element]{remove}{subelement}
|
||||
Removes \var{subelement} from the element.
|
||||
Unlike the findXXX methods this method compares elements based on
|
||||
the instance identity, not on tag value or contents.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -55,40 +55,39 @@ Returns the current font search path.
|
|||
|
||||
Font handle objects support the following operations:
|
||||
|
||||
\setindexsubitem{(font handle method)}
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{scalefont}{factor}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{scalefont}{factor}
|
||||
Returns a handle for a scaled version of this font.
|
||||
Calls \code{fmscalefont(\var{fh}, \var{factor})}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{setfont}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{setfont}{}
|
||||
Makes this font the current font.
|
||||
Note: the effect is undone silently when the font handle object is
|
||||
deleted.
|
||||
Calls \code{fmsetfont(\var{fh})}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getfontname}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{getfontname}{}
|
||||
Returns this font's name.
|
||||
Calls \code{fmgetfontname(\var{fh})}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getcomment}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{getcomment}{}
|
||||
Returns the comment string associated with this font.
|
||||
Raises an exception if there is none.
|
||||
Calls \code{fmgetcomment(\var{fh})}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getfontinfo}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{getfontinfo}{}
|
||||
Returns a tuple giving some pertinent data about this font.
|
||||
This is an interface to \code{fmgetfontinfo()}.
|
||||
The returned tuple contains the following numbers:
|
||||
\code{(}\var{printermatched}, \var{fixed_width}, \var{xorig},
|
||||
\var{yorig}, \var{xsize}, \var{ysize}, \var{height},
|
||||
\var{nglyphs}\code{)}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getstrwidth}{string}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[font handle]{getstrwidth}{string}
|
||||
Returns the width, in pixels, of \var{string} when drawn in this font.
|
||||
Calls \code{fmgetstrwidth(\var{fh}, \var{string})}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -36,6 +36,19 @@ lower- or upper-case before the comparison is performed. If you
|
|||
require a case-sensitive comparison regardless of whether that's
|
||||
standard for your operating system, use \function{fnmatchcase()}
|
||||
instead.
|
||||
|
||||
This example will print all file names in the current directory with the
|
||||
extension \code{.txt}:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
import fnmatch
|
||||
import os
|
||||
|
||||
for file in os.listdir('.'):
|
||||
if fnmatch.fnmatch(file, '*.txt'):
|
||||
print file
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{fnmatchcase}{filename, pattern}
|
||||
|
@ -50,6 +63,24 @@ implemented more efficiently.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.2}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{translate}{pattern}
|
||||
Return the shell-style \var{pattern} converted to a regular
|
||||
expression.
|
||||
|
||||
Example:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> import fnmatch, re
|
||||
>>>
|
||||
>>> regex = fnmatch.translate('*.txt')
|
||||
>>> regex
|
||||
'.*\\.txt$'
|
||||
>>> reobj = re.compile(regex)
|
||||
>>> print reobj.match('foobar.txt')
|
||||
<_sre.SRE_Match object at 0x...>
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{seealso}
|
||||
\seemodule{glob}{\UNIX{} shell-style path expansion.}
|
||||
\end{seealso}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -37,12 +37,15 @@ dr-xr-srwt 105 ftp-usr pdmaint 1536 Mar 21 14:32 ..
|
|||
The module defines the following items:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{FTP}{\optional{host\optional{, user\optional{,
|
||||
passwd\optional{, acct}}}}}
|
||||
passwd\optional{, acct\optional{, timeout}}}}}}
|
||||
Return a new instance of the \class{FTP} class. When
|
||||
\var{host} is given, the method call \code{connect(\var{host})} is
|
||||
made. When \var{user} is given, additionally the method call
|
||||
\code{login(\var{user}, \var{passwd}, \var{acct})} is made (where
|
||||
\var{passwd} and \var{acct} default to the empty string when not given).
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if is not specified, or passed as None, the global
|
||||
default timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{all_errors}
|
||||
|
@ -92,7 +95,7 @@ which is used followed by \samp{lines} for the text version or
|
|||
|
||||
\class{FTP} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
Set the instance's debugging level. This controls the amount of
|
||||
debugging output printed. The default, \code{0}, produces no
|
||||
debugging output. A value of \code{1} produces a moderate amount of
|
||||
|
@ -101,22 +104,28 @@ debugging output, generally a single line per request. A value of
|
|||
logging each line sent and received on the control connection.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{connect}{host\optional{, port}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{connect}{host\optional{, port\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
Connect to the given host and port. The default port number is \code{21}, as
|
||||
specified by the FTP protocol specification. It is rarely needed to
|
||||
specify a different port number. This function should be called only
|
||||
once for each instance; it should not be called at all if a host was
|
||||
given when the instance was created. All other methods can only be
|
||||
used after a connection has been made.
|
||||
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for
|
||||
the connection attempt. If is not specified, or passed as None, the
|
||||
object timeout is used (the timeout that you passed when instantiating the
|
||||
class); if the object timeout is also None, the global default timeout
|
||||
setting will be used.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
Return the welcome message sent by the server in reply to the initial
|
||||
connection. (This message sometimes contains disclaimers or help
|
||||
information that may be relevant to the user.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{login}{\optional{user\optional{, passwd\optional{, acct}}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{login}{\optional{user\optional{, passwd\optional{, acct}}}}
|
||||
Log in as the given \var{user}. The \var{passwd} and \var{acct}
|
||||
parameters are optional and default to the empty string. If no
|
||||
\var{user} is specified, it defaults to \code{'anonymous'}. If
|
||||
|
@ -128,23 +137,23 @@ instance was created. Most FTP commands are only allowed after the
|
|||
client has logged in.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{abort}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{abort}{}
|
||||
Abort a file transfer that is in progress. Using this does not always
|
||||
work, but it's worth a try.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sendcmd}{command}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{sendcmd}{command}
|
||||
Send a simple command string to the server and return the response
|
||||
string.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{voidcmd}{command}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{voidcmd}{command}
|
||||
Send a simple command string to the server and handle the response.
|
||||
Return nothing if a response code in the range 200--299 is received.
|
||||
Raise an exception otherwise.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{retrbinary}{command,
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{retrbinary}{command,
|
||||
callback\optional{, maxblocksize\optional{, rest}}}
|
||||
Retrieve a file in binary transfer mode. \var{command} should be an
|
||||
appropriate \samp{RETR} command: \code{'RETR \var{filename}'}.
|
||||
|
@ -157,7 +166,7 @@ read on the low-level socket object created to do the actual transfer
|
|||
same thing as in the \method{transfercmd()} method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{retrlines}{command\optional{, callback}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{retrlines}{command\optional{, callback}}
|
||||
Retrieve a file or directory listing in \ASCII{} transfer mode.
|
||||
\var{command} should be an appropriate \samp{RETR} command (see
|
||||
\method{retrbinary()}) or a \samp{LIST} command (usually just the string
|
||||
|
@ -166,13 +175,13 @@ with the trailing CRLF stripped. The default \var{callback} prints
|
|||
the line to \code{sys.stdout}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_pasv}{boolean}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{set_pasv}{boolean}
|
||||
Enable ``passive'' mode if \var{boolean} is true, other disable
|
||||
passive mode. (In Python 2.0 and before, passive mode was off by
|
||||
default; in Python 2.1 and later, it is on by default.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{storbinary}{command, file\optional{, blocksize}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{storbinary}{command, file\optional{, blocksize}}
|
||||
Store a file in binary transfer mode. \var{command} should be an
|
||||
appropriate \samp{STOR} command: \code{"STOR \var{filename}"}.
|
||||
\var{file} is an open file object which is read until \EOF{} using its
|
||||
|
@ -181,14 +190,14 @@ data to be stored. The \var{blocksize} argument defaults to 8192.
|
|||
\versionchanged[default for \var{blocksize} added]{2.1}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{storlines}{command, file}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{storlines}{command, file}
|
||||
Store a file in \ASCII{} transfer mode. \var{command} should be an
|
||||
appropriate \samp{STOR} command (see \method{storbinary()}). Lines are
|
||||
read until \EOF{} from the open file object \var{file} using its
|
||||
\method{readline()} method to provide the data to be stored.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{transfercmd}{cmd\optional{, rest}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{transfercmd}{cmd\optional{, rest}}
|
||||
Initiate a transfer over the data connection. If the transfer is
|
||||
active, send a \samp{EPRT} or \samp{PORT} command and the transfer command specified
|
||||
by \var{cmd}, and accept the connection. If the server is passive,
|
||||
|
@ -210,7 +219,7 @@ not recognize the \samp{REST} command, an
|
|||
simply call \method{transfercmd()} without a \var{rest} argument.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{ntransfercmd}{cmd\optional{, rest}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{ntransfercmd}{cmd\optional{, rest}}
|
||||
Like \method{transfercmd()}, but returns a tuple of the data
|
||||
connection and the expected size of the data. If the expected size
|
||||
could not be computed, \code{None} will be returned as the expected
|
||||
|
@ -218,14 +227,14 @@ size. \var{cmd} and \var{rest} means the same thing as in
|
|||
\method{transfercmd()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{nlst}{argument\optional{, \ldots}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{nlst}{argument\optional{, \ldots}}
|
||||
Return a list of files as returned by the \samp{NLST} command. The
|
||||
optional \var{argument} is a directory to list (default is the current
|
||||
server directory). Multiple arguments can be used to pass
|
||||
non-standard options to the \samp{NLST} command.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{dir}{argument\optional{, \ldots}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{dir}{argument\optional{, \ldots}}
|
||||
Produce a directory listing as returned by the \samp{LIST} command,
|
||||
printing it to standard output. The optional \var{argument} is a
|
||||
directory to list (default is the current server directory). Multiple
|
||||
|
@ -235,41 +244,41 @@ command. If the last argument is a function, it is used as a
|
|||
prints to \code{sys.stdout}. This method returns \code{None}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rename}{fromname, toname}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{rename}{fromname, toname}
|
||||
Rename file \var{fromname} on the server to \var{toname}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{delete}{filename}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{delete}{filename}
|
||||
Remove the file named \var{filename} from the server. If successful,
|
||||
returns the text of the response, otherwise raises
|
||||
\exception{error_perm} on permission errors or
|
||||
\exception{error_reply} on other errors.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{cwd}{pathname}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{cwd}{pathname}
|
||||
Set the current directory on the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{mkd}{pathname}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{mkd}{pathname}
|
||||
Create a new directory on the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pwd}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{pwd}{}
|
||||
Return the pathname of the current directory on the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rmd}{dirname}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{rmd}{dirname}
|
||||
Remove the directory named \var{dirname} on the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{size}{filename}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{size}{filename}
|
||||
Request the size of the file named \var{filename} on the server. On
|
||||
success, the size of the file is returned as an integer, otherwise
|
||||
\code{None} is returned. Note that the \samp{SIZE} command is not
|
||||
standardized, but is supported by many common server implementations.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{quit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{quit}{}
|
||||
Send a \samp{QUIT} command to the server and close the connection.
|
||||
This is the ``polite'' way to close a connection, but it may raise an
|
||||
exception of the server reponds with an error to the
|
||||
|
@ -278,7 +287,7 @@ method which renders the \class{FTP} instance useless for subsequent
|
|||
calls (see below).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[FTP]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the connection unilaterally. This should not be applied to an
|
||||
already closed connection such as after a successful call to
|
||||
\method{quit()}. After this call the \class{FTP} instance should not
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -175,15 +175,15 @@ class C:
|
|||
\code{\var{x} > \var{y}}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{compile}{string, filename, kind\optional{,
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{compile}{source, filename, mode\optional{,
|
||||
flags\optional{, dont_inherit}}}
|
||||
Compile the \var{string} into a code object. Code objects can be
|
||||
Compile the \var{source} into a code object. Code objects can be
|
||||
executed by a call to \function{exec()} or evaluated by a call to
|
||||
\function{eval()}. The \var{filename} argument should
|
||||
give the file from which the code was read; pass some recognizable value
|
||||
if it wasn't read from a file (\code{'<string>'} is commonly used).
|
||||
The \var{kind} argument specifies what kind of code must be
|
||||
compiled; it can be \code{'exec'} if \var{string} consists of a
|
||||
The \var{mode} argument specifies what kind of code must be
|
||||
compiled; it can be \code{'exec'} if \var{source} consists of a
|
||||
sequence of statements, \code{'eval'} if it consists of a single
|
||||
expression, or \code{'single'} if it consists of a single
|
||||
interactive statement (in the latter case, expression statements
|
||||
|
@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ class C:
|
|||
|
||||
The optional arguments \var{flags} and \var{dont_inherit}
|
||||
(which are new in Python 2.2) control which future statements (see
|
||||
\pep{236}) affect the compilation of \var{string}. If neither is
|
||||
\pep{236}) affect the compilation of \var{source}. If neither is
|
||||
present (or both are zero) the code is compiled with those future
|
||||
statements that are in effect in the code that is calling compile.
|
||||
If the \var{flags} argument is given and \var{dont_inherit} is not
|
||||
|
@ -582,8 +582,9 @@ class C:
|
|||
\begin{funcdesc}{isinstance}{object, classinfo}
|
||||
Return true if the \var{object} argument is an instance of the
|
||||
\var{classinfo} argument, or of a (direct or indirect) subclass
|
||||
thereof. Also return true if \var{classinfo} is a type object and
|
||||
\var{object} is an object of that type. If \var{object} is not a
|
||||
thereof. Also return true if \var{classinfo} is a type object
|
||||
(new-style class) and \var{object} is an object of that type or of a
|
||||
(direct or indirect) subclass thereof. If \var{object} is not a
|
||||
class instance or an object of the given type, the function always
|
||||
returns false. If \var{classinfo} is neither a class object nor a
|
||||
type object, it may be a tuple of class or type objects, or may
|
||||
|
@ -641,6 +642,11 @@ class C:
|
|||
\warning{The contents of this dictionary should not be modified;
|
||||
changes may not affect the values of local variables used by the
|
||||
interpreter.}
|
||||
|
||||
Free variables are returned by \var{locals} when it is called in
|
||||
a function block. Modifications of free variables may not affect
|
||||
the values used by the interpreter. Free variables are not
|
||||
returned in class blocks.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{long}{\optional{x\optional{, radix}}}
|
||||
|
@ -980,7 +986,7 @@ except NameError:
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{reversed}{seq}
|
||||
Return a reverse iterator. \var{seq} must be an object which
|
||||
supports the sequence protocol (the __len__() method and the
|
||||
supports the sequence protocol (the \method{__len__()} method and the
|
||||
\method{__getitem__()} method with integer arguments starting at
|
||||
\code{0}).
|
||||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
|
@ -1148,7 +1154,7 @@ class C(B):
|
|||
as detailed below.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{type}{name, bases, dict}
|
||||
\begin{funcdescni}{type}{name, bases, dict}
|
||||
Return a new type object. This is essentially a dynamic form of the
|
||||
\keyword{class} statement. The \var{name} string is the class name
|
||||
and becomes the \member{__name__} attribute; the \var{bases} tuple
|
||||
|
@ -1165,7 +1171,7 @@ class C(B):
|
|||
>>> X = type('X', (object,), dict(a=1))
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\versionadded{2.2}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{funcdescni}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{unichr}{i}
|
||||
Return the Unicode string of one character whose Unicode code is the
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -102,9 +102,9 @@ If no translation is found, return \var{singular} if \var{n} is 1;
|
|||
return \var{plural} otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
The Plural formula is taken from the catalog header. It is a C or
|
||||
Python expression that has a free variable n; the expression evaluates
|
||||
Python expression that has a free variable \var{n}; the expression evaluates
|
||||
to the index of the plural in the catalog. See the GNU gettext
|
||||
documentation for the precise syntax to be used in .po files, and the
|
||||
documentation for the precise syntax to be used in \file{.po} files and the
|
||||
formulas for a variety of languages.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ This module implements the HMAC algorithm as described by \rfc{2104}.
|
|||
Return a new hmac object. If \var{msg} is present, the method call
|
||||
\code{update(\var{msg})} is made. \var{digestmod} is the digest
|
||||
constructor or module for the HMAC object to use. It defaults to
|
||||
the \code{\refmodule{hashlib}.md5} constructor. \note{The md5 hash
|
||||
the \function{\refmodule{hashlib}.md5} constructor. \note{The md5 hash
|
||||
has known weaknesses but remains the default for backwards compatibility.
|
||||
Choose a better one for your application.}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -48,25 +48,25 @@ information).
|
|||
|
||||
Profile objects have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{addinfo}{key, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{addinfo}{key, value}
|
||||
Add an arbitrary labelled value to the profile output.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the logfile and terminate the profiler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{fileno}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{fileno}{}
|
||||
Return the file descriptor of the profiler's log file.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{run}{cmd}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{run}{cmd}
|
||||
Profile an \function{exec()}-compatible string in the script environment.
|
||||
The globals from the \refmodule[main]{__main__} module are used as
|
||||
both the globals and locals for the script.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{runcall}{func, *args, **keywords}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{runcall}{func, *args, **keywords}
|
||||
Profile a single call of a callable.
|
||||
Additional positional and keyword arguments may be passed
|
||||
along; the result of the call is returned, and exceptions are
|
||||
|
@ -75,16 +75,16 @@ disabled on the way out.
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{runctx}{cmd, globals, locals}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{runctx}{cmd, globals, locals}
|
||||
Profile an \function{exec()}-compatible string in a specific environment.
|
||||
The string is compiled before profiling begins.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{start}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{start}{}
|
||||
Start the profiler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{stop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Profile]{stop}{}
|
||||
Stop the profiler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -96,11 +96,11 @@ error while parsing.
|
|||
In addition to tag methods, the \class{HTMLParser} class provides some
|
||||
additional methods and instance variables for use within tag methods.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{formatter}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTMLParser]{formatter}
|
||||
This is the formatter instance associated with the parser.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{nofill}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTMLParser]{nofill}
|
||||
Boolean flag which should be true when whitespace should not be
|
||||
collapsed, or false when it should be. In general, this should only
|
||||
be true when character data is to be treated as ``preformatted'' text,
|
||||
|
@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ affects the operation of \method{handle_data()} and \method{save_end()}.
|
|||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{anchor_bgn}{href, name, type}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTMLParser]{anchor_bgn}{href, name, type}
|
||||
This method is called at the start of an anchor region. The arguments
|
||||
correspond to the attributes of the \code{<A>} tag with the same
|
||||
names. The default implementation maintains a list of hyperlinks
|
||||
|
@ -118,27 +118,27 @@ document. The list of hyperlinks is available as the data attribute
|
|||
\member{anchorlist}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{anchor_end}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTMLParser]{anchor_end}{}
|
||||
This method is called at the end of an anchor region. The default
|
||||
implementation adds a textual footnote marker using an index into the
|
||||
list of hyperlinks created by \method{anchor_bgn()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handle_image}{source, alt\optional{, ismap\optional{,
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTMLParser]{handle_image}{source, alt\optional{, ismap\optional{,
|
||||
align\optional{, width\optional{, height}}}}}
|
||||
This method is called to handle images. The default implementation
|
||||
simply passes the \var{alt} value to the \method{handle_data()}
|
||||
method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{save_bgn}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTMLParser]{save_bgn}{}
|
||||
Begins saving character data in a buffer instead of sending it to the
|
||||
formatter object. Retrieve the stored data via \method{save_end()}.
|
||||
Use of the \method{save_bgn()} / \method{save_end()} pair may not be
|
||||
nested.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{save_end}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTMLParser]{save_end}{}
|
||||
Ends buffering character data and returns all data saved since the
|
||||
preceding call to \method{save_bgn()}. If the \member{nofill} flag is
|
||||
false, whitespace is collapsed to single spaces. A call to this
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -75,14 +75,18 @@ This method is called to handle the start of a tag. It is intended to
|
|||
be overridden by a derived class; the base class implementation does
|
||||
nothing.
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{tag} argument is the name of the tag converted to
|
||||
lower case. The \var{attrs} argument is a list of \code{(\var{name},
|
||||
\var{value})} pairs containing the attributes found inside the tag's
|
||||
\code{<>} brackets. The \var{name} will be translated to lower case
|
||||
and double quotes and backslashes in the \var{value} have been
|
||||
interpreted. For instance, for the tag \code{<A
|
||||
HREF="http://www.cwi.nl/">}, this method would be called as
|
||||
The \var{tag} argument is the name of the tag converted to lower case.
|
||||
The \var{attrs} argument is a list of \code{(\var{name}, \var{value})}
|
||||
pairs containing the attributes found inside the tag's \code{<>}
|
||||
brackets. The \var{name} will be translated to lower case, and quotes
|
||||
in the \var{value} have been removed, and character and entity
|
||||
references have been replaced. For instance, for the tag \code{<A
|
||||
HREF="http://www.cwi.nl/">}, this method would be called as
|
||||
\samp{handle_starttag('a', [('href', 'http://www.cwi.nl/')])}.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionchanged[All entity references from htmlentitydefs are now
|
||||
replaced in the attribute values]{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handle_startendtag}{tag, attrs}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -26,18 +26,27 @@ that use HTTP and HTTPS.
|
|||
|
||||
The module provides the following classes:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{HTTPConnection}{host\optional{, port}}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{HTTPConnection}{host\optional{, port\optional{,
|
||||
strict\optional{, timeout}}}}
|
||||
An \class{HTTPConnection} instance represents one transaction with an HTTP
|
||||
server. It should be instantiated passing it a host and optional port number.
|
||||
If no port number is passed, the port is extracted from the host string if it
|
||||
has the form \code{\var{host}:\var{port}}, else the default HTTP port (80) is
|
||||
used. For example, the following calls all create instances that connect to
|
||||
used. When True, the optional parameter \var{strict}
|
||||
causes \code{BadStatusLine} to be raised if the status line can't be parsed
|
||||
as a valid HTTP/1.0 or 1.1 status line. If the optional \var{timeout}
|
||||
parameter is given, connection attempts will timeout after that many
|
||||
seconds (if it is not given or \code{None}, the global default
|
||||
timeout setting is used).
|
||||
|
||||
For example, the following calls all create instances that connect to
|
||||
the server at the same host and port:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> h1 = httplib.HTTPConnection('www.cwi.nl')
|
||||
>>> h2 = httplib.HTTPConnection('www.cwi.nl:80')
|
||||
>>> h3 = httplib.HTTPConnection('www.cwi.nl', 80)
|
||||
>>> h3 = httplib.HTTPConnection('www.cwi.nl', 80, timeout=10)
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\versionadded{2.0}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
@ -300,7 +309,7 @@ Example: \code{httplib.responses[httplib.NOT_FOUND]} is \code{'Not Found'}.
|
|||
|
||||
\class{HTTPConnection} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{request}{method, url\optional{, body\optional{, headers}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{request}{method, url\optional{, body\optional{, headers}}}
|
||||
This will send a request to the server using the HTTP request method
|
||||
\var{method} and the selector \var{url}. If the \var{body} argument is
|
||||
present, it should be a string of data to send after the headers are finished.
|
||||
|
@ -314,24 +323,24 @@ with the request.
|
|||
\versionchanged[\var{body} can be a file object]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getresponse}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{getresponse}{}
|
||||
Should be called after a request is sent to get the response from the server.
|
||||
Returns an \class{HTTPResponse} instance.
|
||||
\note{Note that you must have read the whole response before you can send a new
|
||||
request to the server.}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
Set the debugging level (the amount of debugging output printed).
|
||||
The default debug level is \code{0}, meaning no debugging output is
|
||||
printed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{connect}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{connect}{}
|
||||
Connect to the server specified when the object was created.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the connection to the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -339,7 +348,7 @@ As an alternative to using the \method{request()} method described above,
|
|||
you can also send your request step by step, by using the four functions
|
||||
below.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{putrequest}{request, selector\optional{,
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{putrequest}{request, selector\optional{,
|
||||
skip\_host\optional{, skip_accept_encoding}}}
|
||||
This should be the first call after the connection to the server has
|
||||
been made. It sends a line to the server consisting of the
|
||||
|
@ -351,18 +360,18 @@ with non-False values.
|
|||
\versionchanged[\var{skip_accept_encoding} argument added]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{putheader}{header, argument\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{putheader}{header, argument\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
Send an \rfc{822}-style header to the server. It sends a line to the
|
||||
server consisting of the header, a colon and a space, and the first
|
||||
argument. If more arguments are given, continuation lines are sent,
|
||||
each consisting of a tab and an argument.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{endheaders}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{endheaders}{}
|
||||
Send a blank line to the server, signalling the end of the headers.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{send}{data}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPConnection]{send}{data}
|
||||
Send data to the server. This should be used directly only after the
|
||||
\method{endheaders()} method has been called and before
|
||||
\method{getresponse()} is called.
|
||||
|
@ -372,34 +381,34 @@ Send data to the server. This should be used directly only after the
|
|||
|
||||
\class{HTTPResponse} instances have the following methods and attributes:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{\optional{amt}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPResponse]{read}{\optional{amt}}
|
||||
Reads and returns the response body, or up to the next \var{amt} bytes.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getheader}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPResponse]{getheader}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
Get the contents of the header \var{name}, or \var{default} if there is no
|
||||
matching header.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getheaders}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[HTTPResponse]{getheaders}{}
|
||||
Return a list of (header, value) tuples. \versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{msg}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTTPResponse]{msg}
|
||||
A \class{mimetools.Message} instance containing the response headers.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{version}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTTPResponse]{version}
|
||||
HTTP protocol version used by server. 10 for HTTP/1.0, 11 for HTTP/1.1.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{status}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTTPResponse]{status}
|
||||
Status code returned by server.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{reason}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[HTTPResponse]{reason}
|
||||
Reason phrase returned by server.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Examples \label{httplib-examples}}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -153,11 +153,11 @@ can contain an asterisk to indicate an infinite upper bound
|
|||
An \class{IMAP4} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{append}{mailbox, flags, date_time, message}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{append}{mailbox, flags, date_time, message}
|
||||
Append \var{message} to named mailbox.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{authenticate}{mechanism, authobject}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{authenticate}{mechanism, authobject}
|
||||
Authenticate command --- requires response processing.
|
||||
|
||||
\var{mechanism} specifies which authentication mechanism is to be
|
||||
|
@ -176,115 +176,115 @@ data = authobject(response)
|
|||
be sent instead.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{check}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{check}{}
|
||||
Checkpoint mailbox on server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{close}{}
|
||||
Close currently selected mailbox. Deleted messages are removed from
|
||||
writable mailbox. This is the recommended command before
|
||||
\samp{LOGOUT}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{copy}{message_set, new_mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{copy}{message_set, new_mailbox}
|
||||
Copy \var{message_set} messages onto end of \var{new_mailbox}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{create}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{create}{mailbox}
|
||||
Create new mailbox named \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{delete}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{delete}{mailbox}
|
||||
Delete old mailbox named \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{deleteacl}{mailbox, who}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{deleteacl}{mailbox, who}
|
||||
Delete the ACLs (remove any rights) set for who on mailbox.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{expunge}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{expunge}{}
|
||||
Permanently remove deleted items from selected mailbox. Generates an
|
||||
\samp{EXPUNGE} response for each deleted message. Returned data
|
||||
contains a list of \samp{EXPUNGE} message numbers in order
|
||||
received.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{fetch}{message_set, message_parts}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{fetch}{message_set, message_parts}
|
||||
Fetch (parts of) messages. \var{message_parts} should be
|
||||
a string of message part names enclosed within parentheses,
|
||||
eg: \samp{"(UID BODY[TEXT])"}. Returned data are tuples
|
||||
of message part envelope and data.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getacl}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{getacl}{mailbox}
|
||||
Get the \samp{ACL}s for \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
The method is non-standard, but is supported by the \samp{Cyrus} server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getannotation}{mailbox, entry, attribute}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{getannotation}{mailbox, entry, attribute}
|
||||
Retrieve the specified \samp{ANNOTATION}s for \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
The method is non-standard, but is supported by the \samp{Cyrus} server.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getquota}{root}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{getquota}{root}
|
||||
Get the \samp{quota} \var{root}'s resource usage and limits.
|
||||
This method is part of the IMAP4 QUOTA extension defined in rfc2087.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getquotaroot}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{getquotaroot}{mailbox}
|
||||
Get the list of \samp{quota} \samp{roots} for the named \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
This method is part of the IMAP4 QUOTA extension defined in rfc2087.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{list}{\optional{directory\optional{, pattern}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{list}{\optional{directory\optional{, pattern}}}
|
||||
List mailbox names in \var{directory} matching
|
||||
\var{pattern}. \var{directory} defaults to the top-level mail
|
||||
folder, and \var{pattern} defaults to match anything. Returned data
|
||||
contains a list of \samp{LIST} responses.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{login}{user, password}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{login}{user, password}
|
||||
Identify the client using a plaintext password.
|
||||
The \var{password} will be quoted.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{login_cram_md5}{user, password}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{login_cram_md5}{user, password}
|
||||
Force use of \samp{CRAM-MD5} authentication when identifying the
|
||||
client to protect the password. Will only work if the server
|
||||
\samp{CAPABILITY} response includes the phrase \samp{AUTH=CRAM-MD5}.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{logout}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{logout}{}
|
||||
Shutdown connection to server. Returns server \samp{BYE} response.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{lsub}{\optional{directory\optional{, pattern}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{lsub}{\optional{directory\optional{, pattern}}}
|
||||
List subscribed mailbox names in directory matching pattern.
|
||||
\var{directory} defaults to the top level directory and
|
||||
\var{pattern} defaults to match any mailbox.
|
||||
Returned data are tuples of message part envelope and data.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{myrights}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{myrights}{mailbox}
|
||||
Show my ACLs for a mailbox (i.e. the rights that I have on mailbox).
|
||||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{namespace}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{namespace}{}
|
||||
Returns IMAP namespaces as defined in RFC2342.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{noop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{noop}{}
|
||||
Send \samp{NOOP} to server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{open}{host, port}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{open}{host, port}
|
||||
Opens socket to \var{port} at \var{host}.
|
||||
The connection objects established by this method
|
||||
will be used in the \code{read}, \code{readline}, \code{send}, and
|
||||
|
@ -292,42 +292,42 @@ data = authobject(response)
|
|||
You may override this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{partial}{message_num, message_part, start, length}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{partial}{message_num, message_part, start, length}
|
||||
Fetch truncated part of a message.
|
||||
Returned data is a tuple of message part envelope and data.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{proxyauth}{user}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{proxyauth}{user}
|
||||
Assume authentication as \var{user}.
|
||||
Allows an authorised administrator to proxy into any user's mailbox.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{size}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{read}{size}
|
||||
Reads \var{size} bytes from the remote server.
|
||||
You may override this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readline}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{readline}{}
|
||||
Reads one line from the remote server.
|
||||
You may override this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{recent}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{recent}{}
|
||||
Prompt server for an update. Returned data is \code{None} if no new
|
||||
messages, else value of \samp{RECENT} response.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rename}{oldmailbox, newmailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{rename}{oldmailbox, newmailbox}
|
||||
Rename mailbox named \var{oldmailbox} to \var{newmailbox}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{response}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{response}{code}
|
||||
Return data for response \var{code} if received, or
|
||||
\code{None}. Returns the given code, instead of the usual type.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{search}{charset, criterion\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{search}{charset, criterion\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
Search mailbox for matching messages. \var{charset} may be
|
||||
\code{None}, in which case no \samp{CHARSET} will be specified in the
|
||||
request to the server. The IMAP protocol requires that at least one
|
||||
|
@ -345,45 +345,45 @@ typ, msgnums = M.search(None, '(FROM "LDJ")')
|
|||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{select}{\optional{mailbox\optional{, readonly}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{select}{\optional{mailbox\optional{, readonly}}}
|
||||
Select a mailbox. Returned data is the count of messages in
|
||||
\var{mailbox} (\samp{EXISTS} response). The default \var{mailbox}
|
||||
is \code{'INBOX'}. If the \var{readonly} flag is set, modifications
|
||||
to the mailbox are not allowed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{send}{data}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{send}{data}
|
||||
Sends \code{data} to the remote server.
|
||||
You may override this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setacl}{mailbox, who, what}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{setacl}{mailbox, who, what}
|
||||
Set an \samp{ACL} for \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
The method is non-standard, but is supported by the \samp{Cyrus} server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setannotation}{mailbox, entry, attribute\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{setannotation}{mailbox, entry, attribute\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
Set \samp{ANNOTATION}s for \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
The method is non-standard, but is supported by the \samp{Cyrus} server.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setquota}{root, limits}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{setquota}{root, limits}
|
||||
Set the \samp{quota} \var{root}'s resource \var{limits}.
|
||||
This method is part of the IMAP4 QUOTA extension defined in rfc2087.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{shutdown}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{shutdown}{}
|
||||
Close connection established in \code{open}.
|
||||
You may override this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{socket}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{socket}{}
|
||||
Returns socket instance used to connect to server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sort}{sort_criteria, charset, search_criterion\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{sort}{sort_criteria, charset, search_criterion\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
The \code{sort} command is a variant of \code{search} with sorting
|
||||
semantics for the results. Returned data contains a space separated
|
||||
list of matching message numbers.
|
||||
|
@ -402,11 +402,11 @@ typ, msgnums = M.search(None, '(FROM "LDJ")')
|
|||
This is an \samp{IMAP4rev1} extension command.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{status}{mailbox, names}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{status}{mailbox, names}
|
||||
Request named status conditions for \var{mailbox}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{store}{message_set, command, flag_list}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{store}{message_set, command, flag_list}
|
||||
Alters flag dispositions for messages in mailbox. \var{command} is
|
||||
specified by section 6.4.6 of \rfc{2060} as being one of "FLAGS", "+FLAGS",
|
||||
or "-FLAGS", optionally with a suffix of ".SILENT".
|
||||
|
@ -421,11 +421,11 @@ M.expunge()
|
|||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{subscribe}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{subscribe}{mailbox}
|
||||
Subscribe to new mailbox.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{thread}{threading_algorithm, charset,
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{thread}{threading_algorithm, charset,
|
||||
search_criterion\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
The \code{thread} command is a variant of \code{search} with
|
||||
threading semantics for the results. Returned data contains a space
|
||||
|
@ -448,18 +448,18 @@ M.expunge()
|
|||
This is an \samp{IMAP4rev1} extension command. \versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{uid}{command, arg\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{uid}{command, arg\optional{, ...}}
|
||||
Execute command args with messages identified by UID, rather than
|
||||
message number. Returns response appropriate to command. At least
|
||||
one argument must be supplied; if none are provided, the server will
|
||||
return an error and an exception will be raised.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{unsubscribe}{mailbox}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{unsubscribe}{mailbox}
|
||||
Unsubscribe from old mailbox.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{xatom}{name\optional{, arg\optional{, ...}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4]{xatom}{name\optional{, arg\optional{, ...}}}
|
||||
Allow simple extension commands notified by server in
|
||||
\samp{CAPABILITY} response.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -467,7 +467,7 @@ M.expunge()
|
|||
|
||||
Instances of \class{IMAP4_SSL} have just one additional method:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{ssl}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[IMAP4_SSL]{ssl}{}
|
||||
Returns SSLObject instance used for the secure connection with the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -475,12 +475,12 @@ Instances of \class{IMAP4_SSL} have just one additional method:
|
|||
The following attributes are defined on instances of \class{IMAP4}:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{PROTOCOL_VERSION}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[IMAP4]{PROTOCOL_VERSION}
|
||||
The most recent supported protocol in the
|
||||
\samp{CAPABILITY} response from the server.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{debug}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[IMAP4]{debug}
|
||||
Integer value to control debugging output. The initialize value is
|
||||
taken from the module variable \code{Debug}. Values greater than
|
||||
three trace each command.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -364,13 +364,13 @@ Loggers have the following attributes and methods. Note that Loggers are
|
|||
never instantiated directly, but always through the module-level function
|
||||
\function{logging.getLogger(name)}.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{propagate}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Logger]{propagate}
|
||||
If this evaluates to false, logging messages are not passed by this
|
||||
logger or by child loggers to higher level (ancestor) loggers. The
|
||||
constructor sets this attribute to 1.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setLevel}{lvl}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{setLevel}{lvl}
|
||||
Sets the threshold for this logger to \var{lvl}. Logging messages
|
||||
which are less severe than \var{lvl} will be ignored. When a logger is
|
||||
created, the level is set to \constant{NOTSET} (which causes all messages
|
||||
|
@ -393,21 +393,21 @@ messages will be processed. Otherwise, the root's level will be used
|
|||
as the effective level.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{isEnabledFor}{lvl}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{isEnabledFor}{lvl}
|
||||
Indicates if a message of severity \var{lvl} would be processed by
|
||||
this logger. This method checks first the module-level level set by
|
||||
\function{logging.disable(lvl)} and then the logger's effective level as
|
||||
determined by \method{getEffectiveLevel()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getEffectiveLevel}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{getEffectiveLevel}{}
|
||||
Indicates the effective level for this logger. If a value other than
|
||||
\constant{NOTSET} has been set using \method{setLevel()}, it is returned.
|
||||
Otherwise, the hierarchy is traversed towards the root until a value
|
||||
other than \constant{NOTSET} is found, and that value is returned.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{debug}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{debug}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{DEBUG} on this logger.
|
||||
The \var{msg} is the message format string, and the \var{args} are the
|
||||
arguments which are merged into \var{msg} using the string formatting
|
||||
|
@ -462,67 +462,67 @@ above example). In such circumstances, it is likely that specialized
|
|||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{info}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{info}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{INFO} on this logger.
|
||||
The arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{warning}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{warning}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{WARNING} on this logger.
|
||||
The arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{error}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{error}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{ERROR} on this logger.
|
||||
The arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{critical}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{critical}{msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{CRITICAL} on this logger.
|
||||
The arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{log}{lvl, msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{log}{lvl, msg\optional{, *args\optional{, **kwargs}}}
|
||||
Logs a message with integer level \var{lvl} on this logger.
|
||||
The other arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{exception}{msg\optional{, *args}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{exception}{msg\optional{, *args}}
|
||||
Logs a message with level \constant{ERROR} on this logger.
|
||||
The arguments are interpreted as for \method{debug()}. Exception info
|
||||
is added to the logging message. This method should only be called
|
||||
from an exception handler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{addFilter}{filt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{addFilter}{filt}
|
||||
Adds the specified filter \var{filt} to this logger.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{removeFilter}{filt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{removeFilter}{filt}
|
||||
Removes the specified filter \var{filt} from this logger.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{filter}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{filter}{record}
|
||||
Applies this logger's filters to the record and returns a true value if
|
||||
the record is to be processed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{addHandler}{hdlr}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{addHandler}{hdlr}
|
||||
Adds the specified handler \var{hdlr} to this logger.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{removeHandler}{hdlr}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{removeHandler}{hdlr}
|
||||
Removes the specified handler \var{hdlr} from this logger.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{findCaller}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{findCaller}{}
|
||||
Finds the caller's source filename and line number. Returns the filename,
|
||||
line number and function name as a 3-element tuple.
|
||||
\versionchanged[The function name was added. In earlier versions, the
|
||||
filename and line number were returned as a 2-element tuple.]{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handle}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{handle}{record}
|
||||
Handles a record by passing it to all handlers associated with this logger
|
||||
and its ancestors (until a false value of \var{propagate} is found).
|
||||
This method is used for unpickled records received from a socket, as well
|
||||
|
@ -530,8 +530,8 @@ as those created locally. Logger-level filtering is applied using
|
|||
\method{filter()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{makeRecord}{name, lvl, fn, lno, msg, args, exc_info
|
||||
\optional{, func, extra}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Logger]{makeRecord}{name, lvl, fn, lno, msg, args, exc_info
|
||||
\optional{, func, extra}}
|
||||
This is a factory method which can be overridden in subclasses to create
|
||||
specialized \class{LogRecord} instances.
|
||||
\versionchanged[\var{func} and \var{extra} were added]{2.5}
|
||||
|
@ -875,66 +875,66 @@ Handlers have the following attributes and methods. Note that
|
|||
base for more useful subclasses. However, the \method{__init__()}
|
||||
method in subclasses needs to call \method{Handler.__init__()}.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__init__}{level=\constant{NOTSET}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{__init__}{level=\constant{NOTSET}}
|
||||
Initializes the \class{Handler} instance by setting its level, setting
|
||||
the list of filters to the empty list and creating a lock (using
|
||||
\method{createLock()}) for serializing access to an I/O mechanism.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{createLock}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{createLock}{}
|
||||
Initializes a thread lock which can be used to serialize access to
|
||||
underlying I/O functionality which may not be threadsafe.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{acquire}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{acquire}{}
|
||||
Acquires the thread lock created with \method{createLock()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{release}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{release}{}
|
||||
Releases the thread lock acquired with \method{acquire()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setLevel}{lvl}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{setLevel}{lvl}
|
||||
Sets the threshold for this handler to \var{lvl}. Logging messages which are
|
||||
less severe than \var{lvl} will be ignored. When a handler is created, the
|
||||
level is set to \constant{NOTSET} (which causes all messages to be processed).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{setFormatter}{form}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{setFormatter}{form}
|
||||
Sets the \class{Formatter} for this handler to \var{form}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{addFilter}{filt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{addFilter}{filt}
|
||||
Adds the specified filter \var{filt} to this handler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{removeFilter}{filt}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{removeFilter}{filt}
|
||||
Removes the specified filter \var{filt} from this handler.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{filter}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{filter}{record}
|
||||
Applies this handler's filters to the record and returns a true value if
|
||||
the record is to be processed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{flush}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{flush}{}
|
||||
Ensure all logging output has been flushed. This version does
|
||||
nothing and is intended to be implemented by subclasses.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{close}{}
|
||||
Tidy up any resources used by the handler. This version does
|
||||
nothing and is intended to be implemented by subclasses.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handle}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{handle}{record}
|
||||
Conditionally emits the specified logging record, depending on
|
||||
filters which may have been added to the handler. Wraps the actual
|
||||
emission of the record with acquisition/release of the I/O thread
|
||||
lock.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handleError}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{handleError}{record}
|
||||
This method should be called from handlers when an exception is
|
||||
encountered during an \method{emit()} call. By default it does nothing,
|
||||
which means that exceptions get silently ignored. This is what is
|
||||
|
@ -945,12 +945,12 @@ handler if you wish. The specified record is the one which was being
|
|||
processed when the exception occurred.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{format}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{format}{record}
|
||||
Do formatting for a record - if a formatter is set, use it.
|
||||
Otherwise, use the default formatter for the module.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{emit}{record}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Handler]{emit}{record}
|
||||
Do whatever it takes to actually log the specified logging record.
|
||||
This version is intended to be implemented by subclasses and so
|
||||
raises a \exception{NotImplementedError}.
|
||||
|
@ -1138,9 +1138,6 @@ and \var{port}.
|
|||
Closes the socket.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handleError}{}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{emit}{}
|
||||
Pickles the record's attribute dictionary and writes it to the socket in
|
||||
binary format. If there is an error with the socket, silently drops the
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1203,7 +1203,6 @@ correspond:
|
|||
\end{tableii}
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Exceptions}
|
||||
\label{mailbox-deprecated}
|
||||
|
||||
The following exception classes are defined in the \module{mailbox} module:
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -1247,7 +1246,7 @@ in preference to them.
|
|||
Older mailbox objects support only iteration and provide a single public
|
||||
method:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{next}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[oldmailbox]{next}{}
|
||||
Return the next message in the mailbox, created with the optional \var{factory}
|
||||
argument passed into the mailbox object's constructor. By default this is an
|
||||
\class{rfc822.Message} object (see the \refmodule{rfc822} module). Depending
|
||||
|
@ -1286,13 +1285,13 @@ For maximum portability, messages in a \UNIX-style mailbox are
|
|||
separated by any line that begins exactly with the string \code{'From
|
||||
'} (note the trailing space) if preceded by exactly two newlines.
|
||||
Because of the wide-range of variations in practice, nothing else on
|
||||
the From_ line should be considered. However, the current
|
||||
the \samp{From_} line should be considered. However, the current
|
||||
implementation doesn't check for the leading two newlines. This is
|
||||
usually fine for most applications.
|
||||
|
||||
The \class{UnixMailbox} class implements a more strict version of
|
||||
From_ line checking, using a regular expression that usually correctly
|
||||
matched From_ delimiters. It considers delimiter line to be separated
|
||||
\samp{From_} line checking, using a regular expression that usually correctly
|
||||
matched \samp{From_} delimiters. It considers delimiter line to be separated
|
||||
by \samp{From \var{name} \var{time}} lines. For maximum portability,
|
||||
use the \class{PortableUnixMailbox} class instead. This class is
|
||||
identical to \class{UnixMailbox} except that individual messages are
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ open file \var{output}. The block size is currently fixed at 8192.
|
|||
The \class{Message} class defines the following methods in
|
||||
addition to the \class{rfc822.Message} methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getplist}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getplist}{}
|
||||
Return the parameter list of the \mailheader{Content-Type} header.
|
||||
This is a list of strings. For parameters of the form
|
||||
\samp{\var{key}=\var{value}}, \var{key} is converted to lower case but
|
||||
|
@ -86,34 +86,34 @@ This is a list of strings. For parameters of the form
|
|||
'spam=2', 'Spam']}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getparam}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getparam}{name}
|
||||
Return the \var{value} of the first parameter (as returned by
|
||||
\method{getplist()}) of the form \samp{\var{name}=\var{value}} for the
|
||||
given \var{name}. If \var{value} is surrounded by quotes of the form
|
||||
`\code{<}...\code{>}' or `\code{"}...\code{"}', these are removed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getencoding}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getencoding}{}
|
||||
Return the encoding specified in the
|
||||
\mailheader{Content-Transfer-Encoding} message header. If no such
|
||||
header exists, return \code{'7bit'}. The encoding is converted to
|
||||
lower case.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{gettype}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{gettype}{}
|
||||
Return the message type (of the form \samp{\var{type}/\var{subtype}})
|
||||
as specified in the \mailheader{Content-Type} header. If no such
|
||||
header exists, return \code{'text/plain'}. The type is converted to
|
||||
lower case.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getmaintype}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getmaintype}{}
|
||||
Return the main type as specified in the \mailheader{Content-Type}
|
||||
header. If no such header exists, return \code{'text'}. The main
|
||||
type is converted to lower case.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getsubtype}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getsubtype}{}
|
||||
Return the subtype as specified in the \mailheader{Content-Type}
|
||||
header. If no such header exists, return \code{'plain'}. The subtype
|
||||
is converted to lower case.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -178,49 +178,49 @@ An example usage of the module:
|
|||
\class{MimeTypes} instances provide an interface which is very like
|
||||
that of the \refmodule{mimetypes} module.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{suffix_map}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MimeTypes]{suffix_map}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping suffixes to suffixes. This is used to allow
|
||||
recognition of encoded files for which the encoding and the type are
|
||||
indicated by the same extension. For example, the \file{.tgz}
|
||||
extension is mapped to \file{.tar.gz} to allow the encoding and type
|
||||
to be recognized separately. This is initially a copy of the global
|
||||
\code{suffix_map} defined in the module.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{encodings_map}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MimeTypes]{encodings_map}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping filename extensions to encoding types. This is
|
||||
initially a copy of the global \code{encodings_map} defined in the
|
||||
module.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{types_map}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MimeTypes]{types_map}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping filename extensions to MIME types. This is
|
||||
initially a copy of the global \code{types_map} defined in the
|
||||
module.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{common_types}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MimeTypes]{common_types}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping filename extensions to non-standard, but commonly
|
||||
found MIME types. This is initially a copy of the global
|
||||
\code{common_types} defined in the module.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{guess_extension}{type\optional{, strict}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeTypes]{guess_extension}{type\optional{, strict}}
|
||||
Similar to the \function{guess_extension()} function, using the
|
||||
tables stored as part of the object.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{guess_type}{url\optional{, strict}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeTypes]{guess_type}{url\optional{, strict}}
|
||||
Similar to the \function{guess_type()} function, using the tables
|
||||
stored as part of the object.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{path}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeTypes]{read}{path}
|
||||
Load MIME information from a file named \var{path}. This uses
|
||||
\method{readfp()} to parse the file.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readfp}{file}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeTypes]{readfp}{file}
|
||||
Load MIME type information from an open file. The file must have
|
||||
the format of the standard \file{mime.types} files.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ writing. Note that a \class{StringIO} object could also be used.
|
|||
|
||||
\class{MimeWriter} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{addheader}{key, value\optional{, prefix}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{addheader}{key, value\optional{, prefix}}
|
||||
Add a header line to the MIME message. The \var{key} is the name of
|
||||
the header, where the \var{value} obviously provides the value of the
|
||||
header. The optional argument \var{prefix} determines where the header
|
||||
|
@ -39,14 +39,14 @@ is inserted; \samp{0} means append at the end, \samp{1} is insert at
|
|||
the start. The default is to append.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{flushheaders}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{flushheaders}{}
|
||||
Causes all headers accumulated so far to be written out (and
|
||||
forgotten). This is useful if you don't need a body part at all,
|
||||
e.g.\ for a subpart of type \mimetype{message/rfc822} that's (mis)used
|
||||
to store some header-like information.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{startbody}{ctype\optional{, plist\optional{, prefix}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{startbody}{ctype\optional{, plist\optional{, prefix}}}
|
||||
Returns a file-like object which can be used to write to the
|
||||
body of the message. The content-type is set to the provided
|
||||
\var{ctype}, and the optional parameter \var{plist} provides
|
||||
|
@ -55,8 +55,8 @@ functions as in \method{addheader()} except that the default is to
|
|||
insert at the start.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{startmultipartbody}{subtype\optional{,
|
||||
boundary\optional{, plist\optional{, prefix}}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{startmultipartbody}{subtype\optional{,
|
||||
boundary\optional{, plist\optional{, prefix}}}}
|
||||
Returns a file-like object which can be used to write to the
|
||||
body of the message. Additionally, this method initializes the
|
||||
multi-part code, where \var{subtype} provides the multipart subtype,
|
||||
|
@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ multi-part code, where \var{subtype} provides the multipart subtype,
|
|||
created using \method{nextpart()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{nextpart}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{nextpart}{}
|
||||
Returns a new instance of \class{MimeWriter} which represents an
|
||||
individual part in a multipart message. This may be used to write the
|
||||
part as well as used for creating recursively complex multipart
|
||||
|
@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ messages. The message must first be initialized with
|
|||
\method{startmultipartbody()} before using \method{nextpart()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{lastpart}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MimeWriter]{lastpart}{}
|
||||
This is used to designate the last part of a multipart message, and
|
||||
should \emph{always} be used when writing multipart messages.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -89,18 +89,18 @@ the underlying file. \versionchanged[To map anonymous memory,
|
|||
Memory-mapped file objects support the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the file. Subsequent calls to other methods of the object
|
||||
will result in an exception being raised.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{find}{string\optional{, start}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{find}{string\optional{, start}}
|
||||
Returns the lowest index in the object where the substring
|
||||
\var{string} is found. Returns \code{-1} on failure. \var{start}
|
||||
is the index at which the search begins, and defaults to zero.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{flush}{\optional{offset, size}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{flush}{\optional{offset, size}}
|
||||
Flushes changes made to the in-memory copy of a file back to disk.
|
||||
Without use of this call there is no guarantee that changes are
|
||||
written back before the object is destroyed. If \var{offset} and
|
||||
|
@ -109,36 +109,36 @@ Memory-mapped file objects support the following methods:
|
|||
is flushed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{move}{\var{dest}, \var{src}, \var{count}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{move}{\var{dest}, \var{src}, \var{count}}
|
||||
Copy the \var{count} bytes starting at offset \var{src} to the
|
||||
destination index \var{dest}. If the mmap was created with
|
||||
\constant{ACCESS_READ}, then calls to move will throw a
|
||||
\exception{TypeError} exception.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{\var{num}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{read}{\var{num}}
|
||||
Return a string containing up to \var{num} bytes starting from the
|
||||
current file position; the file position is updated to point after the
|
||||
bytes that were returned.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_byte}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{read_byte}{}
|
||||
Returns a string of length 1 containing the character at the current
|
||||
file position, and advances the file position by 1.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readline}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{readline}{}
|
||||
Returns a single line, starting at the current file position and up to
|
||||
the next newline.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{resize}{\var{newsize}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{resize}{\var{newsize}}
|
||||
Resizes the map and the underlying file, if any.
|
||||
If the mmap was created with \constant{ACCESS_READ} or
|
||||
\constant{ACCESS_COPY}, resizing the map will throw a \exception{TypeError} exception.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{seek}{pos\optional{, whence}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{seek}{pos\optional{, whence}}
|
||||
Set the file's current position. \var{whence} argument is optional
|
||||
and defaults to \code{os.SEEK_SET} or \code{0} (absolute file
|
||||
positioning); other values are \code{os.SEEK_CUR} or \code{1} (seek
|
||||
|
@ -146,16 +146,16 @@ Memory-mapped file objects support the following methods:
|
|||
(seek relative to the file's end).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{size}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{size}{}
|
||||
Return the length of the file, which can be larger than the size of
|
||||
the memory-mapped area.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{tell}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{tell}{}
|
||||
Returns the current position of the file pointer.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write}{\var{string}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{write}{\var{string}}
|
||||
Write the bytes in \var{string} into memory at the current position
|
||||
of the file pointer; the file position is updated to point after the
|
||||
bytes that were written. If the mmap was created with
|
||||
|
@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ Memory-mapped file objects support the following methods:
|
|||
\exception{TypeError} exception.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write_byte}{\var{byte}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mmap]{write_byte}{\var{byte}}
|
||||
Write the single-character string \var{byte} into memory at the
|
||||
current position of the file pointer; the file position is advanced
|
||||
by \code{1}. If the mmap was created with \constant{ACCESS_READ},
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -121,17 +121,17 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
|
||||
\subsection{Database Objects\label{database-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{OpenView}{sql}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Database]{OpenView}{sql}
|
||||
Return a view object, by calling \cfunction{MSIDatabaseOpenView}.
|
||||
\var{sql} is the SQL statement to execute.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Commit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Database]{Commit}{}
|
||||
Commit the changes pending in the current transaction,
|
||||
by calling \cfunction{MSIDatabaseCommit}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{GetSummaryInformation}{count}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Database]{GetSummaryInformation}{count}
|
||||
Return a new summary information object, by calling
|
||||
\cfunction{MsiGetSummaryInformation}. \var{count} is the maximum number of
|
||||
updated values.
|
||||
|
@ -145,24 +145,24 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
|
||||
\subsection{View Objects\label{view-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Execute}{\optional{params=None}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[View]{Execute}{\optional{params=None}}
|
||||
Execute the SQL query of the view, through \cfunction{MSIViewExecute}.
|
||||
\var{params} is an optional record describing actual values
|
||||
of the parameter tokens in the query.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{GetColumnInfo}{kind}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[View]{GetColumnInfo}{kind}
|
||||
Return a record describing the columns of the view, through
|
||||
calling \cfunction{MsiViewGetColumnInfo}. \var{kind} can be either
|
||||
\code{MSICOLINFO_NAMES} or \code{MSICOLINFO_TYPES}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Fetch}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[View]{Fetch}{}
|
||||
Return a result record of the query, through calling
|
||||
\cfunction{MsiViewFetch}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Modify}{kind, data}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[View]{Modify}{kind, data}
|
||||
Modify the view, by calling \cfunction{MsiViewModify}. \var{kind}
|
||||
can be one of \code{MSIMODIFY_SEEK}, \code{MSIMODIFY_REFRESH},
|
||||
\code{MSIMODIFY_INSERT}, \code{MSIMODIFY_UPDATE}, \code{MSIMODIFY_ASSIGN},
|
||||
|
@ -174,7 +174,7 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
\var{data} must be a record describing the new data.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[View]{Close}{}
|
||||
Close the view, through \cfunction{MsiViewClose}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
|
||||
\subsection{Summary Information Objects\label{summary-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{GetProperty}{field}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SummaryInformation]{GetProperty}{field}
|
||||
Return a property of the summary, through \cfunction{MsiSummaryInfoGetProperty}.
|
||||
\var{field} is the name of the property, and can be one of the
|
||||
constants
|
||||
|
@ -200,19 +200,19 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
\code{PID_APPNAME}, or \code{PID_SECURITY}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{GetPropertyCount}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SummaryInformation]{GetPropertyCount}{}
|
||||
Return the number of summary properties, through
|
||||
\cfunction{MsiSummaryInfoGetPropertyCount}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{SetProperty}{field, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SummaryInformation]{SetProperty}{field, value}
|
||||
Set a property through \cfunction{MsiSummaryInfoSetProperty}. \var{field}
|
||||
can have the same values as in \method{GetProperty}, \var{value}
|
||||
is the new value of the property. Possible value types are integer
|
||||
and string.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{Persist}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SummaryInformation]{Persist}{}
|
||||
Write the modified properties to the summary information stream,
|
||||
using \cfunction{MsiSummaryInfoPersist}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -226,27 +226,27 @@ MSI routines, and standard table structures.
|
|||
|
||||
\subsection{Record Objects\label{record-objects}}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{GetFieldCount}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Record]{GetFieldCount}{}
|
||||
Return the number of fields of the record, through \cfunction{MsiRecordGetFieldCount}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{SetString}{field, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Record]{SetString}{field, value}
|
||||
Set \var{field} to \var{value} through \cfunction{MsiRecordSetString}.
|
||||
\var{field} must be an integer; \var{value} a string.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{SetStream}{field, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Record]{SetStream}{field, value}
|
||||
Set \var{field} to the contents of the file named \var{value},
|
||||
through \cfunction{MsiRecordSetStream}.
|
||||
\var{field} must be an integer; \var{value} a string.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{SetInteger}{field, value}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Record]{SetInteger}{field, value}
|
||||
Set \var{field} to \var{value} through \cfunction{MsiRecordSetInteger}.
|
||||
Both \var{field} and \var{value} must be an integer.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{ClearData}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Record]{ClearData}{}
|
||||
Set all fields of the record to 0, through \cfunction{MsiRecordClearData}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -274,7 +274,7 @@ the string inside the exception will contain more detail.
|
|||
\var{name} is the name of the CAB file in the MSI file.
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CAB]{append}{full, logical}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CAB]{append}{full, file, logical}
|
||||
Add the file with the pathname \var{full} to the CAB file,
|
||||
under the name \var{logical}. If there is already a file
|
||||
named \var{logical}, a new file name is created.
|
||||
|
@ -283,7 +283,7 @@ the string inside the exception will contain more detail.
|
|||
new name of the file inside the CAB file.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CAB]{append}{database}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CAB]{commit}{database}
|
||||
Generate a CAB file, add it as a stream to the MSI file,
|
||||
put it into the \code{Media} table, and remove the generated
|
||||
file from the disk.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ own pattern for section-divider and end-marker lines.
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{MultiFile} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readline}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{readline}{str}
|
||||
Read a line. If the line is data (not a section-divider or end-marker
|
||||
or real EOF) return it. If the line matches the most-recently-stacked
|
||||
boundary, return \code{''} and set \code{self.last} to 1 or 0 according as
|
||||
|
@ -58,33 +58,33 @@ underlying stream object, the method raises \exception{Error} unless
|
|||
all boundaries have been popped.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{readlines}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{readlines}{str}
|
||||
Return all lines remaining in this part as a list of strings.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{read}{}
|
||||
Read all lines, up to the next section. Return them as a single
|
||||
(multiline) string. Note that this doesn't take a size argument!
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{seek}{pos\optional{, whence}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{seek}{pos\optional{, whence}}
|
||||
Seek. Seek indices are relative to the start of the current section.
|
||||
The \var{pos} and \var{whence} arguments are interpreted as for a file
|
||||
seek.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{tell}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{tell}{}
|
||||
Return the file position relative to the start of the current section.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{next}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{next}{}
|
||||
Skip lines to the next section (that is, read lines until a
|
||||
section-divider or end-marker has been consumed). Return true if
|
||||
there is such a section, false if an end-marker is seen. Re-enable
|
||||
the most-recently-pushed boundary.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{is_data}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{is_data}{str}
|
||||
Return true if \var{str} is data and false if it might be a section
|
||||
boundary. As written, it tests for a prefix other than \code{'-}\code{-'} at
|
||||
start of line (which all MIME boundaries have) but it is declared so
|
||||
|
@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ boundary tests; if it always returns false it will merely slow
|
|||
processing, not cause it to fail.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{push}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{push}{str}
|
||||
Push a boundary string. When a decorated version of this boundary
|
||||
is found as an input line, it will be interpreted as a section-divider
|
||||
or end-marker (depending on the decoration, see \rfc{2045}). All subsequent
|
||||
|
@ -108,12 +108,12 @@ most-recently-pushed boundary will return EOF; encountering any other
|
|||
boundary will raise an error.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{pop}{}
|
||||
Pop a section boundary. This boundary will no longer be interpreted
|
||||
as EOF.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{section_divider}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{section_divider}{str}
|
||||
Turn a boundary into a section-divider line. By default, this
|
||||
method prepends \code{'-}\code{-'} (which MIME section boundaries have) but
|
||||
it is declared so it can be overridden in derived classes. This
|
||||
|
@ -121,7 +121,7 @@ method need not append LF or CR-LF, as comparison with the result
|
|||
ignores trailing whitespace.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{end_marker}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MultiFile]{end_marker}{str}
|
||||
Turn a boundary string into an end-marker line. By default, this
|
||||
method prepends \code{'-}\code{-'} and appends \code{'-}\code{-'} (like a
|
||||
MIME-multipart end-of-message marker) but it is declared so it can be
|
||||
|
@ -131,11 +131,11 @@ CR-LF, as comparison with the result ignores trailing whitespace.
|
|||
|
||||
Finally, \class{MultiFile} instances have two public instance variables:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{level}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MultiFile]{level}
|
||||
Nesting depth of the current part.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{last}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[MultiFile]{last}
|
||||
True if the last end-of-file was for an end-of-message marker.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -35,23 +35,23 @@ acquired.
|
|||
|
||||
\class{mutex} objects have following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{test}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mutex]{test}{}
|
||||
Check whether the mutex is locked.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{testandset}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mutex]{testandset}{}
|
||||
``Atomic'' test-and-set, grab the lock if it is not set,
|
||||
and return \code{True}, otherwise, return \code{False}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{lock}{function, argument}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mutex]{lock}{function, argument}
|
||||
Execute \code{\var{function}(\var{argument})}, unless the mutex is locked.
|
||||
In the case it is locked, place the function and argument on the queue.
|
||||
See \method{unlock} for explanation of when
|
||||
\code{\var{function}(\var{argument})} is executed in that case.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{unlock}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[mutex]{unlock}{}
|
||||
Unlock the mutex if queue is empty, otherwise execute the first element
|
||||
in the queue.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ of the error, \member{filename} is the name of the source file, and
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{netrc} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{authenticators}{host}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[netrc]{authenticators}{host}
|
||||
Return a 3-tuple \code{(\var{login}, \var{account}, \var{password})}
|
||||
of authenticators for \var{host}. If the netrc file did not
|
||||
contain an entry for the given host, return the tuple associated with
|
||||
|
@ -43,20 +43,20 @@ the `default' entry. If neither matching host nor default entry is
|
|||
available, return \code{None}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__repr__}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[netrc]{__repr__}{}
|
||||
Dump the class data as a string in the format of a netrc file.
|
||||
(This discards comments and may reorder the entries.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
Instances of \class{netrc} have public instance variables:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{hosts}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[netrc]{hosts}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping host names to \code{(\var{login}, \var{account},
|
||||
\var{password})} tuples. The `default' entry, if any, is represented
|
||||
as a pseudo-host by that name.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{macros}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[netrc]{macros}
|
||||
Dictionary mapping macro names to string lists.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -121,13 +121,13 @@ If the server's response indicates an error, the method raises one of
|
|||
the above exceptions.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
Return the welcome message sent by the server in reply to the initial
|
||||
connection. (This message sometimes contains disclaimers or help
|
||||
information that may be relevant to the user.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
Set the instance's debugging level. This controls the amount of
|
||||
debugging output printed. The default, \code{0}, produces no debugging
|
||||
output. A value of \code{1} produces a moderate amount of debugging
|
||||
|
@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ logging each line sent and received on the connection (including
|
|||
message text).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{newgroups}{date, time, \optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{newgroups}{date, time, \optional{file}}
|
||||
Send a \samp{NEWGROUPS} command. The \var{date} argument should be a
|
||||
string of the form \code{'\var{yy}\var{mm}\var{dd}'} indicating the
|
||||
date, and \var{time} should be a string of the form
|
||||
|
@ -152,7 +152,7 @@ calling \method{write()} on it to store the lines of the command output.
|
|||
If \var{file} is supplied, then the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{newnews}{group, date, time, \optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{newnews}{group, date, time, \optional{file}}
|
||||
Send a \samp{NEWNEWS} command. Here, \var{group} is a group name or
|
||||
\code{'*'}, and \var{date} and \var{time} have the same meaning as for
|
||||
\method{newgroups()}. Return a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
||||
|
@ -165,7 +165,7 @@ calling \method{write()} on it to store the lines of the command output.
|
|||
If \var{file} is supplied, then the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{list}{\optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{list}{\optional{file}}
|
||||
Send a \samp{LIST} command. Return a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
||||
\var{list})} where \var{list} is a list of tuples. Each tuple has the
|
||||
form \code{(\var{group}, \var{last}, \var{first}, \var{flag})}, where
|
||||
|
@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ calling \method{write()} on it to store the lines of the command output.
|
|||
If \var{file} is supplied, then the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{descriptions}{grouppattern}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{descriptions}{grouppattern}
|
||||
Send a \samp{LIST NEWSGROUPS} command, where \var{grouppattern} is a wildmat
|
||||
string as specified in RFC2980 (it's essentially the same as DOS or UNIX
|
||||
shell wildcard strings). Return a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
||||
|
@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ shell wildcard strings). Return a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
|||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{description}{group}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{description}{group}
|
||||
Get a description for a single group \var{group}. If more than one group
|
||||
matches (if 'group' is a real wildmat string), return the first match.
|
||||
If no group matches, return an empty string.
|
||||
|
@ -203,7 +203,7 @@ needed, use \method{descriptions()}.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{group}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{group}{name}
|
||||
Send a \samp{GROUP} command, where \var{name} is the group name.
|
||||
Return a tuple \code{(\var{response}, \var{count}, \var{first},
|
||||
\var{last}, \var{name})} where \var{count} is the (estimated) number
|
||||
|
@ -212,7 +212,7 @@ the group, \var{last} is the last article number in the group, and
|
|||
\var{name} is the group name. The numbers are returned as strings.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{help}{\optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{help}{\optional{file}}
|
||||
Send a \samp{HELP} command. Return a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
||||
\var{list})} where \var{list} is a list of help strings.
|
||||
If the \var{file} parameter is supplied, then the output of the
|
||||
|
@ -223,7 +223,7 @@ calling \method{write()} on it to store the lines of the command output.
|
|||
If \var{file} is supplied, then the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{stat}{id}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{stat}{id}
|
||||
Send a \samp{STAT} command, where \var{id} is the message id (enclosed
|
||||
in \character{<} and \character{>}) or an article number (as a string).
|
||||
Return a triple \code{(\var{response}, \var{number}, \var{id})} where
|
||||
|
@ -231,15 +231,15 @@ Return a triple \code{(\var{response}, \var{number}, \var{id})} where
|
|||
message id (enclosed in \character{<} and \character{>}).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{next}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{next}{}
|
||||
Send a \samp{NEXT} command. Return as for \method{stat()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{last}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{last}{}
|
||||
Send a \samp{LAST} command. Return as for \method{stat()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{head}{id}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{head}{id}
|
||||
Send a \samp{HEAD} command, where \var{id} has the same meaning as for
|
||||
\method{stat()}. Return a tuple
|
||||
\code{(\var{response}, \var{number}, \var{id}, \var{list})}
|
||||
|
@ -248,7 +248,7 @@ and \var{list} is a list of the article's headers (an uninterpreted
|
|||
list of lines, without trailing newlines).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{body}{id,\optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{body}{id,\optional{file}}
|
||||
Send a \samp{BODY} command, where \var{id} has the same meaning as for
|
||||
\method{stat()}. If the \var{file} parameter is supplied, then
|
||||
the body is stored in a file. If \var{file} is a string, then
|
||||
|
@ -259,16 +259,16 @@ Return as for \method{head()}. If \var{file} is supplied, then
|
|||
the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{article}{id}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{article}{id}
|
||||
Send an \samp{ARTICLE} command, where \var{id} has the same meaning as
|
||||
for \method{stat()}. Return as for \method{head()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{slave}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{slave}{}
|
||||
Send a \samp{SLAVE} command. Return the server's \var{response}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{xhdr}{header, string, \optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{xhdr}{header, string, \optional{file}}
|
||||
Send an \samp{XHDR} command. This command is not defined in the RFC
|
||||
but is a common extension. The \var{header} argument is a header
|
||||
keyword, e.g. \code{'subject'}. The \var{string} argument should have
|
||||
|
@ -286,7 +286,7 @@ calling \method{write()} on it to store the lines of the command output.
|
|||
If \var{file} is supplied, then the returned \var{list} is an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{post}{file}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{post}{file}
|
||||
Post an article using the \samp{POST} command. The \var{file}
|
||||
argument is an open file object which is read until EOF using its
|
||||
\method{readline()} method. It should be a well-formed news article,
|
||||
|
@ -294,14 +294,14 @@ including the required headers. The \method{post()} method
|
|||
automatically escapes lines beginning with \samp{.}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{ihave}{id, file}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{ihave}{id, file}
|
||||
Send an \samp{IHAVE} command. \var{id} is a message id (enclosed in
|
||||
\character{<} and \character{>}).
|
||||
If the response is not an error, treat
|
||||
\var{file} exactly as for the \method{post()} method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{date}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{date}{}
|
||||
Return a triple \code{(\var{response}, \var{date}, \var{time})},
|
||||
containing the current date and time in a form suitable for the
|
||||
\method{newnews()} and \method{newgroups()} methods.
|
||||
|
@ -309,7 +309,7 @@ This is an optional NNTP extension, and may not be supported by all
|
|||
servers.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{xgtitle}{name, \optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{xgtitle}{name, \optional{file}}
|
||||
Process an \samp{XGTITLE} command, returning a pair \code{(\var{response},
|
||||
\var{list})}, where \var{list} is a list of tuples containing
|
||||
\code{(\var{name}, \var{title})}.
|
||||
|
@ -327,7 +327,7 @@ RFC2980 says ``It is suggested that this extension be deprecated''. Use
|
|||
\method{descriptions()} or \method{description()} instead.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{xover}{start, end, \optional{file}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{xover}{start, end, \optional{file}}
|
||||
Return a pair \code{(\var{resp}, \var{list})}. \var{list} is a list
|
||||
of tuples, one for each article in the range delimited by the \var{start}
|
||||
and \var{end} article numbers. Each tuple is of the form
|
||||
|
@ -343,13 +343,13 @@ This is an optional NNTP extension, and may not be supported by all
|
|||
servers.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{xpath}{id}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{xpath}{id}
|
||||
Return a pair \code{(\var{resp}, \var{path})}, where \var{path} is the
|
||||
directory path to the article with message ID \var{id}. This is an
|
||||
optional NNTP extension, and may not be supported by all servers.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{quit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[NNTP]{quit}{}
|
||||
Send a \samp{QUIT} command and close the connection. Once this method
|
||||
has been called, no other methods of the NNTP object should be called.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -518,7 +518,7 @@ program, i.e. \code{os.path.basename(sys.argv{[}0])}. The expanded string
|
|||
is then printed before the detailed option help.
|
||||
|
||||
If you don't supply a usage string, \module{optparse} uses a bland but sensible
|
||||
default: ``\code{usage: {\%}prog {[}options]"}, which is fine if your script
|
||||
default: \code{"usage: {\%}prog {[}options]"}, which is fine if your script
|
||||
doesn't take any positional arguments.
|
||||
|
||||
\item {}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1233,7 +1233,8 @@ Availability: Macintosh, \UNIX, Windows.
|
|||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{walk}{top\optional{, topdown\code{=True}
|
||||
\optional{, onerror\code{=None}}}}
|
||||
\optional{, onerror\code{=None}\optional{,
|
||||
followlinks\code{=False}}}}}
|
||||
\index{directory!walking}
|
||||
\index{directory!traversal}
|
||||
\function{walk()} generates the file names in a directory tree, by
|
||||
|
@ -1273,6 +1274,18 @@ report the error to continue with the walk, or raise the exception
|
|||
to abort the walk. Note that the filename is available as the
|
||||
\code{filename} attribute of the exception object.
|
||||
|
||||
By default, \function{walk()} will not walk down into symbolic links that
|
||||
resolve to directories. Set \var{followlinks} to True to visit directories
|
||||
pointed to by symlinks, on systems that support them.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded[The \var{followlinks} parameter]{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{notice}
|
||||
Be aware that setting \var{followlinks} to true can lead to infinite recursion
|
||||
if a link points to a parent directory of itself. \function{walk()} does not
|
||||
keep track of the directories it visited already.
|
||||
\end{notice}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{notice}
|
||||
If you pass a relative pathname, don't change the current working
|
||||
directory between resumptions of \function{walk()}. \function{walk()}
|
||||
|
@ -1280,15 +1293,6 @@ never changes the current directory, and assumes that its caller
|
|||
doesn't either.
|
||||
\end{notice}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{notice}
|
||||
On systems that support symbolic links, links to subdirectories appear
|
||||
in \var{dirnames} lists, but \function{walk()} will not visit them
|
||||
(infinite loops are hard to avoid when following symbolic links).
|
||||
To visit linked directories, you can identify them with
|
||||
\code{os.path.islink(\var{path})}, and invoke \code{walk(\var{path})}
|
||||
on each directly.
|
||||
\end{notice}
|
||||
|
||||
This example displays the number of bytes taken by non-directory files
|
||||
in each directory under the starting directory, except that it doesn't
|
||||
look under any CVS subdirectory:
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -378,6 +378,14 @@ command with a \samp{global} command on the same line, e.g.:
|
|||
(Pdb)
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
\item[run \optional{\var{args} ...}]
|
||||
Restart the debugged python program. If an argument is supplied, it is
|
||||
splitted with "shlex" and the result is used as the new sys.argv.
|
||||
History, breakpoints, actions and debugger options are preserved.
|
||||
"restart" is an alias for "run".
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\item[q(uit)]
|
||||
|
||||
Quit from the debugger.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -39,21 +39,21 @@ Example:
|
|||
|
||||
Template objects following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{reset}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{reset}{}
|
||||
Restore a pipeline template to its initial state.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{clone}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{clone}{}
|
||||
Return a new, equivalent, pipeline template.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{debug}{flag}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{debug}{flag}
|
||||
If \var{flag} is true, turn debugging on. Otherwise, turn debugging
|
||||
off. When debugging is on, commands to be executed are printed, and
|
||||
the shell is given \code{set -x} command to be more verbose.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{append}{cmd, kind}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{append}{cmd, kind}
|
||||
Append a new action at the end. The \var{cmd} variable must be a valid
|
||||
bourne shell command. The \var{kind} variable consists of two letters.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -68,17 +68,17 @@ command writes a file on the command line) or \code{'.'} (which means
|
|||
the command does not write anything, and hence must be last.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{prepend}{cmd, kind}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{prepend}{cmd, kind}
|
||||
Add a new action at the beginning. See \method{append()} for explanations
|
||||
of the arguments.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{open}{file, mode}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{open}{file, mode}
|
||||
Return a file-like object, open to \var{file}, but read from or
|
||||
written to by the pipeline. Note that only one of \code{'r'},
|
||||
\code{'w'} may be given.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{copy}{infile, outfile}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Template]{copy}{infile, outfile}
|
||||
Copy \var{infile} to \var{outfile} through the pipe.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -80,6 +80,22 @@
|
|||
Returns a string identifying the compiler used for compiling Python.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{python_branch}{}
|
||||
Returns a string identifying the Python implementation SCM branch.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{python_implementation}{}
|
||||
Returns a string identifying the Python implementation.
|
||||
Possible return values are: 'CPython', 'IronPython', 'Jython'
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{python_revision}{}
|
||||
Returns a string identifying the Python implementation SCM revision.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{python_version}{}
|
||||
Returns the Python version as string \code{'major.minor.patchlevel'}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -205,6 +221,7 @@
|
|||
which defaults to the args given as parameters.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
% Document linux_distribution()?
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{libc_ver}{executable=sys.executable, lib='',
|
||||
version='', chunksize=2048}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,7 +2,6 @@
|
|||
Subprocesses with accessible I/O streams}
|
||||
|
||||
\declaremodule{standard}{popen2}
|
||||
\platform{Unix, Windows}
|
||||
\modulesynopsis{Subprocesses with accessible standard I/O streams.}
|
||||
\sectionauthor{Drew Csillag}{drew_csillag@geocities.com}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -85,12 +84,12 @@ using \function{popen4()}.
|
|||
Instances of the \class{Popen3} and \class{Popen4} classes have the
|
||||
following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{poll}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Popen3]{poll}{}
|
||||
Returns \code{-1} if child process hasn't completed yet, or its return
|
||||
code otherwise.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{wait}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Popen3]{wait}{}
|
||||
Waits for and returns the status code of the child process. The
|
||||
status code encodes both the return code of the process and
|
||||
information about whether it exited using the \cfunction{exit()}
|
||||
|
@ -102,24 +101,24 @@ status code are defined in the \refmodule{os} module; see section
|
|||
|
||||
The following attributes are also available:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{fromchild}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen3]{fromchild}
|
||||
A file object that provides output from the child process. For
|
||||
\class{Popen4} instances, this will provide both the standard output
|
||||
and standard error streams.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{tochild}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen3]{tochild}
|
||||
A file object that provides input to the child process.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{childerr}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen3]{childerr}
|
||||
A file object that provides error output from the child process, if
|
||||
\var{capturestderr} was true for the constructor, otherwise
|
||||
\code{None}. This will always be \code{None} for \class{Popen4}
|
||||
instances.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{pid}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen3]{pid}
|
||||
The process ID of the child process.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -23,15 +23,18 @@ servers that use SSL as an underlying protocol layer.
|
|||
Note that POP3, though widely supported, is obsolescent. The
|
||||
implementation quality of POP3 servers varies widely, and too many are
|
||||
quite poor. If your mailserver supports IMAP, you would be better off
|
||||
using the \code{\refmodule{imaplib}.\class{IMAP4}} class, as IMAP
|
||||
using the \class{\refmodule{imaplib}.IMAP4} class, as IMAP
|
||||
servers tend to be better implemented.
|
||||
|
||||
A single class is provided by the \module{poplib} module:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{POP3}{host\optional{, port}}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{POP3}{host\optional{, port\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
This class implements the actual POP3 protocol. The connection is
|
||||
created when the instance is initialized.
|
||||
If \var{port} is omitted, the standard POP3 port (110) is used.
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if not specified, or passed as None, the global default
|
||||
timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{POP3_SSL}{host\optional{, port\optional{, keyfile\optional{, certfile}}}}
|
||||
|
@ -47,8 +50,9 @@ certificate chain file for the SSL connection.
|
|||
One exception is defined as an attribute of the \module{poplib} module:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{excdesc}{error_proto}
|
||||
Exception raised on any errors. The reason for the exception is
|
||||
passed to the constructor as a string.
|
||||
Exception raised on any errors from this module (errors from
|
||||
\module{socket} module are not caught). The reason for the exception
|
||||
is passed to the constructor as a string.
|
||||
\end{excdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{seealso}
|
||||
|
@ -70,7 +74,7 @@ in lower-case; most return the response text sent by the server.
|
|||
An \class{POP3} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
Set the instance's debugging level. This controls the amount of
|
||||
debugging output printed. The default, \code{0}, produces no
|
||||
debugging output. A value of \code{1} produces a moderate amount of
|
||||
|
@ -79,64 +83,64 @@ debugging output, generally a single line per request. A value of
|
|||
logging each line sent and received on the control connection.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{getwelcome}{}
|
||||
Returns the greeting string sent by the POP3 server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{user}{username}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{user}{username}
|
||||
Send user command, response should indicate that a password is required.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pass_}{password}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{pass_}{password}
|
||||
Send password, response includes message count and mailbox size.
|
||||
Note: the mailbox on the server is locked until \method{quit()} is
|
||||
called.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{apop}{user, secret}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{apop}{user, secret}
|
||||
Use the more secure APOP authentication to log into the POP3 server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rpop}{user}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{rpop}{user}
|
||||
Use RPOP authentication (similar to UNIX r-commands) to log into POP3 server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{stat}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{stat}{}
|
||||
Get mailbox status. The result is a tuple of 2 integers:
|
||||
\code{(\var{message count}, \var{mailbox size})}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{list}{\optional{which}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{list}{\optional{which}}
|
||||
Request message list, result is in the form
|
||||
\code{(\var{response}, ['mesg_num octets', ...], \var{octets})}.
|
||||
If \var{which} is set, it is the message to list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{retr}{which}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{retr}{which}
|
||||
Retrieve whole message number \var{which}, and set its seen flag.
|
||||
Result is in form \code{(\var{response}, ['line', ...], \var{octets})}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{dele}{which}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{dele}{which}
|
||||
Flag message number \var{which} for deletion. On most servers
|
||||
deletions are not actually performed until QUIT (the major exception is
|
||||
Eudora QPOP, which deliberately violates the RFCs by doing pending
|
||||
deletes on any disconnect).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rset}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{rset}{}
|
||||
Remove any deletion marks for the mailbox.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{noop}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{noop}{}
|
||||
Do nothing. Might be used as a keep-alive.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{quit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{quit}{}
|
||||
Signoff: commit changes, unlock mailbox, drop connection.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{top}{which, howmuch}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{top}{which, howmuch}
|
||||
Retrieves the message header plus \var{howmuch} lines of the message
|
||||
after the header of message number \var{which}. Result is in form
|
||||
\code{(\var{response}, ['line', ...], \var{octets})}.
|
||||
|
@ -148,7 +152,7 @@ Test this method by hand against the POP3 servers you will use before
|
|||
trusting it.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{uidl}{\optional{which}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[POP3]{uidl}{\optional{which}}
|
||||
Return message digest (unique id) list.
|
||||
If \var{which} is specified, result contains the unique id for that
|
||||
message in the form \code{'\var{response}\ \var{mesgnum}\ \var{uid}},
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -62,8 +62,7 @@ The \module{posixfile} module defines the following functions:
|
|||
|
||||
The posixfile object defines the following additional methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\setindexsubitem{(posixfile method)}
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{lock}{fmt, \optional{len\optional{, start\optional{, whence}}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[posixfile]{lock}{fmt, \optional{len\optional{, start\optional{, whence}}}}
|
||||
Lock the specified section of the file that the file object is
|
||||
referring to. The format is explained
|
||||
below in a table. The \var{len} argument specifies the length of the
|
||||
|
@ -74,9 +73,9 @@ The posixfile object defines the following additional methods:
|
|||
\constant{SEEK_CUR} or \constant{SEEK_END}. The default is
|
||||
\constant{SEEK_SET}. For more information about the arguments refer
|
||||
to the \manpage{fcntl}{2} manual page on your system.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{flags}{\optional{flags}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[posixfile]{flags}{\optional{flags}}
|
||||
Set the specified flags for the file that the file object is referring
|
||||
to. The new flags are ORed with the old flags, unless specified
|
||||
otherwise. The format is explained below in a table. Without
|
||||
|
@ -84,25 +83,25 @@ The posixfile object defines the following additional methods:
|
|||
a string indicating the current flags is returned (this is
|
||||
the same as the \samp{?} modifier). For more information about the
|
||||
flags refer to the \manpage{fcntl}{2} manual page on your system.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{dup}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[posixfile]{dup}{}
|
||||
Duplicate the file object and the underlying file pointer and file
|
||||
descriptor. The resulting object behaves as if it were newly
|
||||
opened.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{dup2}{fd}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[posixfile]{dup2}{fd}
|
||||
Duplicate the file object and the underlying file pointer and file
|
||||
descriptor. The new object will have the given file descriptor.
|
||||
Otherwise the resulting object behaves as if it were newly opened.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{file}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[posixfile]{file}{}
|
||||
Return the standard file object that the posixfile object is based
|
||||
on. This is sometimes necessary for functions that insist on a
|
||||
standard file object.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
All methods raise \exception{IOError} when the request fails.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -58,18 +58,20 @@ Equivalent to \function{exists()} on platforms lacking
|
|||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{expanduser}{path}
|
||||
On \UNIX, return the argument with an initial component of \samp{\~} or
|
||||
\samp{\~\var{user}} replaced by that \var{user}'s home directory.
|
||||
An initial \samp{\~} is replaced by the environment variable
|
||||
On \UNIX{} and Windows, return the argument with an initial component of
|
||||
\samp{\~} or \samp{\~\var{user}} replaced by that \var{user}'s home directory.
|
||||
|
||||
On \UNIX, an initial \samp{\~} is replaced by the environment variable
|
||||
\envvar{HOME} if it is set; otherwise the current user's home directory
|
||||
is looked up in the password directory through the built-in module
|
||||
\refmodule{pwd}\refbimodindex{pwd}.
|
||||
An initial \samp{\~\var{user}} is looked up directly in the
|
||||
password directory.
|
||||
|
||||
On Windows, only \samp{\~} is supported; it is replaced by the
|
||||
environment variable \envvar{HOME} or by a combination of
|
||||
\envvar{HOMEDRIVE} and \envvar{HOMEPATH}.
|
||||
On Windows, \envvar{HOME} and \envvar{USERPROFILE} will be used if set,
|
||||
otherwise a combination of \envvar{HOMEPATH} and \envvar{HOMEDRIVE} will be
|
||||
used. An initial \samp{\~\var{user}} is handled by stripping the last
|
||||
directory component from the created user path derived above.
|
||||
|
||||
If the expansion fails or if the
|
||||
path does not begin with a tilde, the path is returned unchanged.
|
||||
|
@ -81,6 +83,9 @@ of the form \samp{\$\var{name}} or \samp{\$\{\var{name}\}} are
|
|||
replaced by the value of environment variable \var{name}. Malformed
|
||||
variable names and references to non-existing variables are left
|
||||
unchanged.
|
||||
|
||||
On Windows, \samp{\%\var{name}\%} expansions are supported in addition to
|
||||
\samp{\$\var{name}} and \samp{\$\{\var{name}\}}.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getatime}{path}
|
||||
|
@ -184,6 +189,15 @@ operating system).
|
|||
\versionadded{2.2}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{relpath}{path\optional{, start}}
|
||||
Return a relative filepath to \var{path} either from the current
|
||||
directory or from an optional \var{start} point.
|
||||
|
||||
\var{start} defaults to \member{os.curdir}.
|
||||
Availability: Windows, \UNIX.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{samefile}{path1, path2}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if both pathname arguments refer to the same file or
|
||||
directory (as indicated by device number and i-node number).
|
||||
|
@ -234,7 +248,12 @@ empty string. On systems which do not use drive specifications,
|
|||
Split the pathname \var{path} into a pair \code{(\var{root}, \var{ext})}
|
||||
such that \code{\var{root} + \var{ext} == \var{path}},
|
||||
and \var{ext} is empty or begins with a period and contains
|
||||
at most one period.
|
||||
at most one period. Leading periods on the basename are
|
||||
ignored; \code{\var{splitext}.('.cshrc')} returns
|
||||
\code{('.cshrc', '')}.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionchanged[Earlier versions could produce an empty root when
|
||||
the only period was the first character]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{splitunc}{path}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -158,12 +158,12 @@ l/lib/python1.5/test', '/usr/local/lib/python1.5/sunos5', '/usr/local/lib/python
|
|||
\class{PrettyPrinter} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pformat}{object}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[PrettyPrinter]{pformat}{object}
|
||||
Return the formatted representation of \var{object}. This takes into
|
||||
account the options passed to the \class{PrettyPrinter} constructor.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pprint}{object}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[PrettyPrinter]{pprint}{object}
|
||||
Print the formatted representation of \var{object} on the configured
|
||||
stream, followed by a newline.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -173,7 +173,7 @@ corresponding functions of the same names. Using these methods on an
|
|||
instance is slightly more efficient since new \class{PrettyPrinter}
|
||||
objects don't need to be created.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{isreadable}{object}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[PrettyPrinter]{isreadable}{object}
|
||||
Determine if the formatted representation of the object is
|
||||
``readable,'' or can be used to reconstruct the value using
|
||||
\function{eval()}\bifuncindex{eval}. Note that this returns false for
|
||||
|
@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ recursive objects. If the \var{depth} parameter of the
|
|||
this returns false.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{isrecursive}{object}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[PrettyPrinter]{isrecursive}{object}
|
||||
Determine if the object requires a recursive representation.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -190,7 +190,7 @@ This method is provided as a hook to allow subclasses to modify the
|
|||
way objects are converted to strings. The default implementation uses
|
||||
the internals of the \function{saferepr()} implementation.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{format}{object, context, maxlevels, level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[PrettyPrinter]{format}{object, context, maxlevels, level}
|
||||
Returns three values: the formatted version of \var{object} as a
|
||||
string, a flag indicating whether the result is readable, and a flag
|
||||
indicating whether recursion was detected. The first argument is the
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -45,22 +45,22 @@ other queue organizations (e.g. stack) but the inheritable interface
|
|||
is not described here. See the source code for details. The public
|
||||
methods are:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{qsize}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{qsize}{}
|
||||
Return the approximate size of the queue. Because of multithreading
|
||||
semantics, this number is not reliable.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{empty}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{empty}{}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if the queue is empty, \code{False} otherwise.
|
||||
Because of multithreading semantics, this is not reliable.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{full}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{full}{}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if the queue is full, \code{False} otherwise.
|
||||
Because of multithreading semantics, this is not reliable.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{put}{item\optional{, block\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{put}{item\optional{, block\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
Put \var{item} into the queue. If optional args \var{block} is true
|
||||
and \var{timeout} is None (the default), block if necessary until a
|
||||
free slot is available. If \var{timeout} is a positive number, it
|
||||
|
@ -74,11 +74,11 @@ exception (\var{timeout} is ignored in that case).
|
|||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{put_nowait}{item}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{put_nowait}{item}
|
||||
Equivalent to \code{put(\var{item}, False)}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get}{\optional{block\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{get}{\optional{block\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
Remove and return an item from the queue. If optional args
|
||||
\var{block} is true and \var{timeout} is None (the default),
|
||||
block if necessary until an item is available. If \var{timeout} is
|
||||
|
@ -92,14 +92,14 @@ immediately available, else raise the \exception{Empty} exception
|
|||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get_nowait}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{get_nowait}{}
|
||||
Equivalent to \code{get(False)}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
Two methods are offered to support tracking whether enqueued tasks have
|
||||
been fully processed by daemon consumer threads.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{task_done}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{task_done}{}
|
||||
Indicate that a formerly enqueued task is complete. Used by queue consumer
|
||||
threads. For each \method{get()} used to fetch a task, a subsequent call to
|
||||
\method{task_done()} tells the queue that the processing on the task is complete.
|
||||
|
@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ placed in the queue.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{join}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Queue]{join}{}
|
||||
Blocks until all items in the queue have been gotten and processed.
|
||||
|
||||
The count of unfinished tasks goes up whenever an item is added to the
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -812,7 +812,7 @@ used for groups that did not participate in the match; it defaults to
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[MatchObject]{start}{\optional{group}}
|
||||
\methodline{end}{\optional{group}}
|
||||
\methodline[MatchObject]{end}{\optional{group}}
|
||||
Return the indices of the start and end of the substring
|
||||
matched by \var{group}; \var{group} defaults to zero (meaning the whole
|
||||
matched substring).
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -44,18 +44,18 @@ provide size limits for the representations of different object types,
|
|||
and methods which format specific object types.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{maxlevel}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Repr]{maxlevel}
|
||||
Depth limit on the creation of recursive representations. The
|
||||
default is \code{6}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{maxdict}
|
||||
\memberline{maxlist}
|
||||
\memberline{maxtuple}
|
||||
\memberline{maxset}
|
||||
\memberline{maxfrozenset}
|
||||
\memberline{maxdeque}
|
||||
\memberline{maxarray}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Repr]{maxdict}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxlist}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxtuple}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxset}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxfrozenset}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxdeque}
|
||||
\memberline[Repr]{maxarray}
|
||||
Limits on the number of entries represented for the named object
|
||||
type. The default is \code{4} for \member{maxdict}, \code{5} for
|
||||
\member{maxarray}, and \code{6} for the others.
|
||||
|
@ -63,13 +63,13 @@ and methods which format specific object types.
|
|||
and \member{set}]{2.4}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{maxlong}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Repr]{maxlong}
|
||||
Maximum number of characters in the representation for a long
|
||||
integer. Digits are dropped from the middle. The default is
|
||||
\code{40}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{maxstring}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Repr]{maxstring}
|
||||
Limit on the number of characters in the representation of the
|
||||
string. Note that the ``normal'' representation of the string is
|
||||
used as the character source: if escape sequences are needed in the
|
||||
|
@ -77,19 +77,19 @@ and methods which format specific object types.
|
|||
shortened. The default is \code{30}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{maxother}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Repr]{maxother}
|
||||
This limit is used to control the size of object types for which no
|
||||
specific formatting method is available on the \class{Repr} object.
|
||||
It is applied in a similar manner as \member{maxstring}. The
|
||||
default is \code{20}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{repr}{obj}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Repr]{repr}{obj}
|
||||
The equivalent to the built-in \function{repr()} that uses the
|
||||
formatting imposed by the instance.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{repr1}{obj, level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Repr]{repr1}{obj, level}
|
||||
Recursive implementation used by \method{repr()}. This uses the
|
||||
type of \var{obj} to determine which formatting method to call,
|
||||
passing it \var{obj} and \var{level}. The type-specific methods
|
||||
|
@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ and methods which format specific object types.
|
|||
call.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddescni}{repr_\var{type}}{obj, level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddescni}[Repr]{repr_\var{type}}{obj, level}
|
||||
Formatting methods for specific types are implemented as methods
|
||||
with a name based on the type name. In the method name, \var{type}
|
||||
is replaced by
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -89,20 +89,20 @@ makes use of this and would break were it not available.
|
|||
|
||||
\class{RExec} instances support the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_eval}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_eval}{code}
|
||||
\var{code} must either be a string containing a Python expression, or
|
||||
a compiled code object, which will be evaluated in the restricted
|
||||
environment's \module{__main__} module. The value of the expression or
|
||||
code object will be returned.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_exec}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_exec}{code}
|
||||
\var{code} must either be a string containing one or more lines of
|
||||
Python code, or a compiled code object, which will be executed in the
|
||||
restricted environment's \module{__main__} module.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_execfile}{filename}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_execfile}{filename}
|
||||
Execute the Python code contained in the file \var{filename} in the
|
||||
restricted environment's \module{__main__} module.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -112,17 +112,17 @@ beginning with \samp{r_}, but the code will be granted access to
|
|||
restricted versions of the standard I/O streams \code{sys.stdin},
|
||||
\code{sys.stderr}, and \code{sys.stdout}.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_eval}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_eval}{code}
|
||||
\var{code} must be a string containing a Python expression, which will
|
||||
be evaluated in the restricted environment.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_exec}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_exec}{code}
|
||||
\var{code} must be a string containing one or more lines of Python code,
|
||||
which will be executed in the restricted environment.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_execfile}{code}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_execfile}{code}
|
||||
Execute the Python code contained in the file \var{filename} in the
|
||||
restricted environment.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -132,13 +132,13 @@ implicitly called by code executing in the restricted environment.
|
|||
Overriding these methods in a subclass is used to change the policies
|
||||
enforced by a restricted environment.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_import}{modulename\optional{, globals\optional{,
|
||||
locals\optional{, fromlist}}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_import}{modulename\optional{, globals\optional{,
|
||||
locals\optional{, fromlist}}}}
|
||||
Import the module \var{modulename}, raising an \exception{ImportError}
|
||||
exception if the module is considered unsafe.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_open}{filename\optional{, mode\optional{, bufsize}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_open}{filename\optional{, mode\optional{, bufsize}}}
|
||||
Method called when \function{open()} is called in the restricted
|
||||
environment. The arguments are identical to those of \function{open()},
|
||||
and a file object (or a class instance compatible with file objects)
|
||||
|
@ -148,28 +148,28 @@ the example below for an implementation of a less restrictive
|
|||
\method{r_open()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_reload}{module}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_reload}{module}
|
||||
Reload the module object \var{module}, re-parsing and re-initializing it.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{r_unload}{module}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{r_unload}{module}
|
||||
Unload the module object \var{module} (remove it from the
|
||||
restricted environment's \code{sys.modules} dictionary).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
And their equivalents with access to restricted standard I/O streams:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_import}{modulename\optional{, globals\optional{,
|
||||
locals\optional{, fromlist}}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_import}{modulename\optional{, globals\optional{,
|
||||
locals\optional{, fromlist}}}}
|
||||
Import the module \var{modulename}, raising an \exception{ImportError}
|
||||
exception if the module is considered unsafe.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_reload}{module}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_reload}{module}
|
||||
Reload the module object \var{module}, re-parsing and re-initializing it.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{s_unload}{module}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RExec]{s_unload}{module}
|
||||
Unload the module object \var{module}.
|
||||
% XXX what are the semantics of this?
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -184,7 +184,7 @@ instance won't have any effect; instead, create a subclass of
|
|||
Instances of the new class will then use those new values. All these
|
||||
attributes are tuples of strings.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{nok_builtin_names}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{nok_builtin_names}
|
||||
Contains the names of built-in functions which will \emph{not} be
|
||||
available to programs running in the restricted environment. The
|
||||
value for \class{RExec} is \code{('open', 'reload', '__import__')}.
|
||||
|
@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ built-in functions are added to Python, they will also be added to
|
|||
this module.)
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ok_builtin_modules}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{ok_builtin_modules}
|
||||
Contains the names of built-in modules which can be safely imported.
|
||||
The value for \class{RExec} is \code{('audioop', 'array', 'binascii',
|
||||
'cmath', 'errno', 'imageop', 'marshal', 'math', 'md5', 'operator',
|
||||
|
@ -205,14 +205,14 @@ The value for \class{RExec} is \code{('audioop', 'array', 'binascii',
|
|||
applies --- use the value from the base class as a starting point.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ok_path}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{ok_path}
|
||||
Contains the directories which will be searched when an \keyword{import}
|
||||
is performed in the restricted environment.
|
||||
The value for \class{RExec} is the same as \code{sys.path} (at the time
|
||||
the module is loaded) for unrestricted code.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ok_posix_names}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{ok_posix_names}
|
||||
% Should this be called ok_os_names?
|
||||
Contains the names of the functions in the \refmodule{os} module which will be
|
||||
available to programs running in the restricted environment. The
|
||||
|
@ -221,14 +221,14 @@ value for \class{RExec} is \code{('error', 'fstat', 'listdir',
|
|||
'getcwd', 'getuid', 'getgid', 'geteuid', 'getegid')}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ok_sys_names}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{ok_sys_names}
|
||||
Contains the names of the functions and variables in the \refmodule{sys}
|
||||
module which will be available to programs running in the restricted
|
||||
environment. The value for \class{RExec} is \code{('ps1', 'ps2',
|
||||
'copyright', 'version', 'platform', 'exit', 'maxint')}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ok_file_types}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[RExec]{ok_file_types}
|
||||
Contains the file types from which modules are allowed to be loaded.
|
||||
Each file type is an integer constant defined in the \refmodule{imp} module.
|
||||
The meaningful values are \constant{PY_SOURCE}, \constant{PY_COMPILED}, and
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ however, some mailers don't follow that format as specified, so
|
|||
\code{'Mon, 20 Nov 1995 19:12:08 -0500'}. If it succeeds in parsing
|
||||
the date, \function{parsedate()} returns a 9-tuple that can be passed
|
||||
directly to \function{time.mktime()}; otherwise \code{None} will be
|
||||
returned. Note that fields 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
returned. Note that indexes 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
usable.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -114,7 +114,7 @@ offset is the opposite of the sign of the \code{time.timezone}
|
|||
variable for the same timezone; the latter variable follows the
|
||||
\POSIX{} standard while this module follows \rfc{2822}.) If the input
|
||||
string has no timezone, the last element of the tuple returned is
|
||||
\code{None}. Note that fields 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
\code{None}. Note that indexes 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not
|
||||
usable.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -142,12 +142,12 @@ switch dates. Not enough to worry about for common use.
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{Message} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{rewindbody}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{rewindbody}{}
|
||||
Seek to the start of the message body. This only works if the file
|
||||
object is seekable.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{isheader}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{isheader}{line}
|
||||
Returns a line's canonicalized fieldname (the dictionary key that will
|
||||
be used to index it) if the line is a legal \rfc{2822} header; otherwise
|
||||
returns \code{None} (implying that parsing should stop here and the
|
||||
|
@ -155,33 +155,33 @@ line be pushed back on the input stream). It is sometimes useful to
|
|||
override this method in a subclass.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{islast}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{islast}{line}
|
||||
Return true if the given line is a delimiter on which Message should
|
||||
stop. The delimiter line is consumed, and the file object's read
|
||||
location positioned immediately after it. By default this method just
|
||||
checks that the line is blank, but you can override it in a subclass.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{iscomment}{line}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{iscomment}{line}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if the given line should be ignored entirely, just skipped.
|
||||
By default this is a stub that always returns \code{False}, but you can
|
||||
override it in a subclass.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getallmatchingheaders}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getallmatchingheaders}{name}
|
||||
Return a list of lines consisting of all headers matching
|
||||
\var{name}, if any. Each physical line, whether it is a continuation
|
||||
line or not, is a separate list item. Return the empty list if no
|
||||
header matches \var{name}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getfirstmatchingheader}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getfirstmatchingheader}{name}
|
||||
Return a list of lines comprising the first header matching
|
||||
\var{name}, and its continuation line(s), if any. Return
|
||||
\code{None} if there is no header matching \var{name}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getrawheader}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getrawheader}{name}
|
||||
Return a single string consisting of the text after the colon in the
|
||||
first header matching \var{name}. This includes leading whitespace,
|
||||
the trailing linefeed, and internal linefeeds and whitespace if there
|
||||
|
@ -189,19 +189,19 @@ any continuation line(s) were present. Return \code{None} if there is
|
|||
no header matching \var{name}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getheader}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getheader}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
Like \code{getrawheader(\var{name})}, but strip leading and trailing
|
||||
whitespace. Internal whitespace is not stripped. The optional
|
||||
\var{default} argument can be used to specify a different default to
|
||||
be returned when there is no header matching \var{name}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{get}{name\optional{, default}}
|
||||
An alias for \method{getheader()}, to make the interface more compatible
|
||||
with regular dictionaries.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getaddr}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getaddr}{name}
|
||||
Return a pair \code{(\var{full name}, \var{email address})} parsed
|
||||
from the string returned by \code{getheader(\var{name})}. If no
|
||||
header matching \var{name} exists, return \code{(None, None)};
|
||||
|
@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ If the header contained
|
|||
exact same result.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getaddrlist}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getaddrlist}{name}
|
||||
This is similar to \code{getaddr(\var{list})}, but parses a header
|
||||
containing a list of email addresses (e.g.\ a \mailheader{To} header) and
|
||||
returns a list of \code{(\var{full name}, \var{email address})} pairs
|
||||
|
@ -229,7 +229,7 @@ are several \mailheader{Cc} headers), all are parsed for addresses.
|
|||
Any continuation lines the named headers contain are also parsed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getdate}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getdate}{name}
|
||||
Retrieve a header using \method{getheader()} and parse it into a 9-tuple
|
||||
compatible with \function{time.mktime()}; note that fields 6, 7, and 8
|
||||
are not usable. If there is no header matching
|
||||
|
@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ collection of email from many sources, it is still possible that this
|
|||
function may occasionally yield an incorrect result.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{getdate_tz}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Message]{getdate_tz}{name}
|
||||
Retrieve a header using \method{getheader()} and parse it into a
|
||||
10-tuple; the first 9 elements will make a tuple compatible with
|
||||
\function{time.mktime()}, and the 10th is a number giving the offset
|
||||
|
@ -270,19 +270,19 @@ support the \method{clear()}, \method{copy()}, \method{popitem()}, or
|
|||
|
||||
Finally, \class{Message} instances have some public instance variables:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{headers}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Message]{headers}
|
||||
A list containing the entire set of header lines, in the order in
|
||||
which they were read (except that setitem calls may disturb this
|
||||
order). Each line contains a trailing newline. The
|
||||
blank line terminating the headers is not contained in the list.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{fp}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Message]{fp}
|
||||
The file or file-like object passed at instantiation time. This can
|
||||
be used to read the message content.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{unixfrom}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Message]{unixfrom}
|
||||
The \UNIX{} \samp{From~} line, if the message had one, or an empty
|
||||
string. This is needed to regenerate the message in some contexts,
|
||||
such as an \code{mbox}-style mailbox file.
|
||||
|
@ -293,34 +293,34 @@ such as an \code{mbox}-style mailbox file.
|
|||
|
||||
An \class{AddressList} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__len__}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__len__}{}
|
||||
Return the number of addresses in the address list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__str__}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__str__}{}
|
||||
Return a canonicalized string representation of the address list.
|
||||
Addresses are rendered in "name" <host@domain> form, comma-separated.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__add__}{alist}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__add__}{alist}
|
||||
Return a new \class{AddressList} instance that contains all addresses
|
||||
in both \class{AddressList} operands, with duplicates removed (set
|
||||
union).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__iadd__}{alist}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__iadd__}{alist}
|
||||
In-place version of \method{__add__()}; turns this \class{AddressList}
|
||||
instance into the union of itself and the right-hand instance,
|
||||
\var{alist}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__sub__}{alist}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__sub__}{alist}
|
||||
Return a new \class{AddressList} instance that contains every address
|
||||
in the left-hand \class{AddressList} operand that is not present in
|
||||
the right-hand address operand (set difference).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{__isub__}{alist}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[AddressList]{__isub__}{alist}
|
||||
In-place version of \method{__sub__()}, removing addresses in this
|
||||
list which are also in \var{alist}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
@ -328,7 +328,7 @@ list which are also in \var{alist}.
|
|||
|
||||
Finally, \class{AddressList} instances have one public instance variable:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{addresslist}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[AddressList]{addresslist}
|
||||
A list of tuple string pairs, one per address. In each member, the
|
||||
first is the canonicalized name part, the second is the
|
||||
actual route-address (\character{@}-separated username-host.domain
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ From print_time 930343700.273
|
|||
|
||||
\class{scheduler} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{enterabs}{time, priority, action, argument}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[scheduler]{enterabs}{time, priority, action, argument}
|
||||
Schedule a new event. The \var{time} argument should be a numeric type
|
||||
compatible with the return value of the \var{timefunc} function passed
|
||||
to the constructor. Events scheduled for
|
||||
|
@ -63,23 +63,23 @@ Return value is an event which may be used for later cancellation of
|
|||
the event (see \method{cancel()}).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{enter}{delay, priority, action, argument}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[scheduler]{enter}{delay, priority, action, argument}
|
||||
Schedule an event for \var{delay} more time units. Other then the
|
||||
relative time, the other arguments, the effect and the return value
|
||||
are the same as those for \method{enterabs()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{cancel}{event}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[scheduler]{cancel}{event}
|
||||
Remove the event from the queue. If \var{event} is not an event
|
||||
currently in the queue, this method will raise a
|
||||
\exception{RuntimeError}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{empty}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[scheduler]{empty}{}
|
||||
Return true if the event queue is empty.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{run}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[scheduler]{run}{}
|
||||
Run all scheduled events. This function will wait
|
||||
(using the \function{delayfunc} function passed to the constructor)
|
||||
for the next event, then execute it and so on until there are no more
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -77,7 +77,7 @@ afterward the whole bitmap has to be linearly scanned again.
|
|||
\cfunction{select()} is O(highest file descriptor), while
|
||||
\cfunction{poll()} is O(number of file descriptors).
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register}{fd\optional{, eventmask}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[poll]{register}{fd\optional{, eventmask}}
|
||||
Register a file descriptor with the polling object. Future calls to
|
||||
the \method{poll()} method will then check whether the file descriptor
|
||||
has any pending I/O events. \var{fd} can be either an integer, or an
|
||||
|
@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ error, and has the same effect as registering the descriptor exactly
|
|||
once.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{unregister}{fd}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[poll]{unregister}{fd}
|
||||
Remove a file descriptor being tracked by a polling object. Just like
|
||||
the \method{register()} method, \var{fd} can be an integer or an
|
||||
object with a \method{fileno()} method that returns an integer.
|
||||
|
@ -114,7 +114,7 @@ Attempting to remove a file descriptor that was never registered
|
|||
causes a \exception{KeyError} exception to be raised.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{poll}{\optional{timeout}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[poll]{poll}{\optional{timeout}}
|
||||
Polls the set of registered file descriptors, and returns a
|
||||
possibly-empty list containing \code{(\var{fd}, \var{event})} 2-tuples
|
||||
for the descriptors that have events or errors to report.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ parsing rules. See section~\ref{shlex-objects}.
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{shlex} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get_token}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{get_token}{}
|
||||
Return a token. If tokens have been stacked using
|
||||
\method{push_token()}, pop a token off the stack. Otherwise, read one
|
||||
from the input stream. If reading encounters an immediate
|
||||
|
@ -66,17 +66,17 @@ end-of-file, \member{self.eof} is returned (the empty string (\code{''})
|
|||
in non-\POSIX{} mode, and \code{None} in \POSIX{} mode).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{push_token}{str}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{push_token}{str}
|
||||
Push the argument onto the token stack.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_token}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{read_token}{}
|
||||
Read a raw token. Ignore the pushback stack, and do not interpret source
|
||||
requests. (This is not ordinarily a useful entry point, and is
|
||||
documented here only for the sake of completeness.)
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sourcehook}{filename}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{sourcehook}{filename}
|
||||
When \class{shlex} detects a source request (see
|
||||
\member{source} below) this method is given the following token as
|
||||
argument, and expected to return a tuple consisting of a filename and
|
||||
|
@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ For more explicit control of source stacking, use the
|
|||
\method{push_source()} and \method{pop_source()} methods.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{push_source}{stream\optional{, filename}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{push_source}{stream\optional{, filename}}
|
||||
Push an input source stream onto the input stack. If the filename
|
||||
argument is specified it will later be available for use in error
|
||||
messages. This is the same method used internally by the
|
||||
|
@ -114,14 +114,14 @@ messages. This is the same method used internally by the
|
|||
\versionadded{2.1}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{pop_source}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{pop_source}{}
|
||||
Pop the last-pushed input source from the input stack.
|
||||
This is the same method used internally when the lexer reaches
|
||||
\EOF{} on a stacked input stream.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.1}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{error_leader}{\optional{file\optional{, line}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[shlex]{error_leader}{\optional{file\optional{, line}}}
|
||||
This method generates an error message leader in the format of a
|
||||
\UNIX{} C compiler error label; the format is \code{'"\%s", line \%d: '},
|
||||
where the \samp{\%s} is replaced with the name of the current source
|
||||
|
@ -137,63 +137,63 @@ Instances of \class{shlex} subclasses have some public instance
|
|||
variables which either control lexical analysis or can be used for
|
||||
debugging:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{commenters}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{commenters}
|
||||
The string of characters that are recognized as comment beginners.
|
||||
All characters from the comment beginner to end of line are ignored.
|
||||
Includes just \character{\#} by default.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{wordchars}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{wordchars}
|
||||
The string of characters that will accumulate into multi-character
|
||||
tokens. By default, includes all \ASCII{} alphanumerics and
|
||||
underscore.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{whitespace}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{whitespace}
|
||||
Characters that will be considered whitespace and skipped. Whitespace
|
||||
bounds tokens. By default, includes space, tab, linefeed and
|
||||
carriage-return.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{escape}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{escape}
|
||||
Characters that will be considered as escape. This will be only used
|
||||
in \POSIX{} mode, and includes just \character{\textbackslash} by default.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{quotes}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{quotes}
|
||||
Characters that will be considered string quotes. The token
|
||||
accumulates until the same quote is encountered again (thus, different
|
||||
quote types protect each other as in the shell.) By default, includes
|
||||
\ASCII{} single and double quotes.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{escapedquotes}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{escapedquotes}
|
||||
Characters in \member{quotes} that will interpret escape characters
|
||||
defined in \member{escape}. This is only used in \POSIX{} mode, and
|
||||
includes just \character{"} by default.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{whitespace_split}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{whitespace_split}
|
||||
If \code{True}, tokens will only be split in whitespaces. This is useful, for
|
||||
example, for parsing command lines with \class{shlex}, getting tokens
|
||||
in a similar way to shell arguments.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{infile}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{infile}
|
||||
The name of the current input file, as initially set at class
|
||||
instantiation time or stacked by later source requests. It may
|
||||
be useful to examine this when constructing error messages.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{instream}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{instream}
|
||||
The input stream from which this \class{shlex} instance is reading
|
||||
characters.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{source}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{source}
|
||||
This member is \code{None} by default. If you assign a string to it,
|
||||
that string will be recognized as a lexical-level inclusion request
|
||||
similar to the \samp{source} keyword in various shells. That is, the
|
||||
|
@ -204,23 +204,23 @@ become the original input stream. Source requests may be stacked any
|
|||
number of levels deep.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{debug}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{debug}
|
||||
If this member is numeric and \code{1} or more, a \class{shlex}
|
||||
instance will print verbose progress output on its behavior. If you
|
||||
need to use this, you can read the module source code to learn the
|
||||
details.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{lineno}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{lineno}
|
||||
Source line number (count of newlines seen so far plus one).
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{token}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{token}
|
||||
The token buffer. It may be useful to examine this when catching
|
||||
exceptions.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{eof}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[shlex]{eof}
|
||||
Token used to determine end of file. This will be set to the empty
|
||||
string (\code{''}), in non-\POSIX{} mode, and to \code{None} in
|
||||
\POSIX{} mode.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -34,7 +34,9 @@ file type and creator codes will not be correct.
|
|||
is the buffer size. In particular, a negative \var{length} value
|
||||
means to copy the data without looping over the source data in
|
||||
chunks; by default the data is read in chunks to avoid uncontrolled
|
||||
memory consumption.
|
||||
memory consumption. Note that if the current file position of the
|
||||
\var{fsrc} object is not 0, only the contents from the current file
|
||||
position to the end of the file will be copied.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{copymode}{src, dst}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -15,7 +15,9 @@ CGI environment, using \class{CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler}.
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{SimpleXMLRPCServer}{addr\optional{,
|
||||
requestHandler\optional{,
|
||||
logRequests\optional{, allow_none\optional{, encoding}}}}}
|
||||
logRequests\optional{,
|
||||
allow_none\optional{,
|
||||
encoding}}}}}
|
||||
|
||||
Create a new server instance. This class
|
||||
provides methods for registration of functions that can be called by
|
||||
|
@ -28,8 +30,13 @@ CGI environment, using \class{CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler}.
|
|||
setting this parameter to false will turn off logging.
|
||||
The \var{allow_none} and \var{encoding} parameters are passed on to
|
||||
\module{xmlrpclib} and control the XML-RPC responses that will be returned
|
||||
from the server.
|
||||
from the server. The \var{bind_and_activate} parameter controls whether
|
||||
\method{server_bind()} and \method{server_activate()} are called immediately
|
||||
by the constructor; it defaults to true. Setting it to false allows code to
|
||||
manipulate the \var{allow_reuse_address} class variable before the address
|
||||
is bound.
|
||||
\versionchanged[The \var{allow_none} and \var{encoding} parameters were added]{2.5}
|
||||
\versionchanged[The \var{bind_and_activate} parameter was added]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler}{\optional{allow_none\optional{, encoding}}}
|
||||
|
@ -101,13 +108,13 @@ simple, stand alone XML-RPC servers.
|
|||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_introspection_functions}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SimpleXMLRPCServer]{register_introspection_functions}{}
|
||||
Registers the XML-RPC introspection functions \code{system.listMethods},
|
||||
\code{system.methodHelp} and \code{system.methodSignature}.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_multicall_functions}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SimpleXMLRPCServer]{register_multicall_functions}{}
|
||||
Registers the XML-RPC multicall function system.multicall.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -171,7 +178,7 @@ print s.system.listMethods()
|
|||
The \class{CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler} class can be used to
|
||||
handle XML-RPC requests sent to Python CGI scripts.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_function}{function\optional{, name}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{register_function}{function\optional{, name}}
|
||||
Register a function that can respond to XML-RPC requests. If
|
||||
\var{name} is given, it will be the method name associated with
|
||||
function, otherwise \var{function.__name__} will be used. \var{name}
|
||||
|
@ -180,7 +187,7 @@ characters not legal in Python identifiers, including the period
|
|||
character.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_instance}{instance}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{register_instance}{instance}
|
||||
Register an object which is used to expose method names
|
||||
which have not been registered using \method{register_function()}. If
|
||||
instance contains a \method{_dispatch()} method, it is called with the
|
||||
|
@ -196,17 +203,17 @@ parameters from the request, and the return value is passed
|
|||
back to the client.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_introspection_functions}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{register_introspection_functions}{}
|
||||
Register the XML-RPC introspection functions
|
||||
\code{system.listMethods}, \code{system.methodHelp} and
|
||||
\code{system.methodSignature}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{register_multicall_functions}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{register_multicall_functions}{}
|
||||
Register the XML-RPC multicall function \code{system.multicall}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{handle_request}{\optional{request_text = None}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler]{handle_request}{\optional{request_text = None}}
|
||||
Handle a XML-RPC request. If \var{request_text} is given, it
|
||||
should be the POST data provided by the HTTP server,
|
||||
otherwise the contents of stdin will be used.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -28,12 +28,17 @@ the newly added path for configuration files.
|
|||
|
||||
A path configuration file is a file whose name has the form
|
||||
\file{\var{package}.pth} and exists in one of the four directories
|
||||
mentioned above; its contents are additional items (one
|
||||
per line) to be added to \code{sys.path}. Non-existing items are
|
||||
never added to \code{sys.path}, but no check is made that the item
|
||||
refers to a directory (rather than a file). No item is added to
|
||||
\code{sys.path} more than once. Blank lines and lines beginning with
|
||||
\code{\#} are skipped. Lines starting with \code{import} are executed.
|
||||
mentioned above; its contents are additional items (one per line) to
|
||||
be added to \code{sys.path}. Non-existing items are never added to
|
||||
\code{sys.path}, but no check is made that the item refers to a
|
||||
directory (rather than a file). No item is added to \code{sys.path}
|
||||
more than once. Blank lines and lines beginning with \code{\#} are
|
||||
skipped. Lines starting with \code{import} (followed by space or tab)
|
||||
are executed.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionchanged[A space or tab is now required after the import
|
||||
keyword]{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\index{package}
|
||||
\indexiii{path}{configuration}{file}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -15,13 +15,16 @@ listener daemon. For details of SMTP and ESMTP operation, consult
|
|||
(\citetitle{SMTP Service Extensions}).
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{SMTP}{\optional{host\optional{, port\optional{,
|
||||
local_hostname}}}}
|
||||
local_hostname\optional{, timeout}}}}}
|
||||
A \class{SMTP} instance encapsulates an SMTP connection. It has
|
||||
methods that support a full repertoire of SMTP and ESMTP
|
||||
operations. If the optional host and port parameters are given, the
|
||||
SMTP \method{connect()} method is called with those parameters during
|
||||
initialization. An \exception{SMTPConnectError} is raised if the
|
||||
specified host doesn't respond correctly.
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if not specified, or passed as None, the global
|
||||
default timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
|
||||
For normal use, you should only require the initialization/connect,
|
||||
\method{sendmail()}, and \method{quit()} methods. An example is
|
||||
|
@ -31,7 +34,7 @@ included below.
|
|||
\begin{classdesc}{SMTP_SSL}{\optional{host\optional{, port\optional{,
|
||||
local_hostname\optional{,
|
||||
keyfile\optional{,
|
||||
certfile}}}}}}
|
||||
certfile\optional{, timeout}}}}}}}
|
||||
A \class{SMTP_SSL} instance behaves exactly the same as instances of \class{SMTP}.
|
||||
\class{SMTP_SSL} should be used for situations where SSL is required from
|
||||
the beginning of the connection and using \method{starttls()} is not appropriate.
|
||||
|
@ -39,6 +42,26 @@ If \var{host} is not specified, the local host is used. If \var{port} is
|
|||
omitted, the standard SMTP-over-SSL port (465) is used. \var{keyfile} and \var{certfile}
|
||||
are also optional, and can contain a PEM formatted private key and
|
||||
certificate chain file for the SSL connection.
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if not specified, or passed as None, the global
|
||||
default timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{LMTP}{\optional{host\optional{, port\optional{,
|
||||
local_hostname}}}}
|
||||
|
||||
The LMTP protocol, which is very similar to ESMTP, is heavily based
|
||||
on the standard SMTP client. It's common to use Unix sockets for LMTP,
|
||||
so our connect() method must support that as well as a regular
|
||||
host:port server. To specify a Unix socket, you must use an absolute
|
||||
path for \var{host}, starting with a '/'.
|
||||
|
||||
Authentication is supported, using the regular SMTP mechanism. When
|
||||
using a Unix socket, LMTP generally don't support or require any
|
||||
authentication, but your mileage might vary.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
A nice selection of exceptions is defined as well:
|
||||
|
@ -103,13 +126,13 @@ A nice selection of exceptions is defined as well:
|
|||
|
||||
An \class{SMTP} instance has the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{set_debuglevel}{level}
|
||||
Set the debug output level. A true value for \var{level} results in
|
||||
debug messages for connection and for all messages sent to and
|
||||
received from the server.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{connect}{\optional{host\optional{, port}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{connect}{\optional{host\optional{, port}}}
|
||||
Connect to a host on a given port. The defaults are to connect to the
|
||||
local host at the standard SMTP port (25).
|
||||
If the hostname ends with a colon (\character{:}) followed by a
|
||||
|
@ -119,7 +142,7 @@ This method is automatically invoked by the constructor if a
|
|||
host is specified during instantiation.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{docmd}{cmd, \optional{, argstring}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{docmd}{cmd, \optional{, argstring}}
|
||||
Send a command \var{cmd} to the server. The optional argument
|
||||
\var{argstring} is simply concatenated to the command, separated by a
|
||||
space.
|
||||
|
@ -136,7 +159,7 @@ If the connection to the server is lost while waiting for the reply,
|
|||
\exception{SMTPServerDisconnected} will be raised.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{helo}{\optional{hostname}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{helo}{\optional{hostname}}
|
||||
Identify yourself to the SMTP server using \samp{HELO}. The hostname
|
||||
argument defaults to the fully qualified domain name of the local
|
||||
host.
|
||||
|
@ -146,7 +169,7 @@ explicitly. It will be implicitly called by the \method{sendmail()}
|
|||
when necessary.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{ehlo}{\optional{hostname}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{ehlo}{\optional{hostname}}
|
||||
Identify yourself to an ESMTP server using \samp{EHLO}. The hostname
|
||||
argument defaults to the fully qualified domain name of the local
|
||||
host. Examine the response for ESMTP option and store them for use by
|
||||
|
@ -157,13 +180,13 @@ mail, it should not be necessary to call this method explicitly. It
|
|||
will be implicitly called by \method{sendmail()} when necessary.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{has_extn}{name}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{has_extn}{name}
|
||||
Return \constant{True} if \var{name} is in the set of SMTP service
|
||||
extensions returned by the server, \constant{False} otherwise.
|
||||
Case is ignored.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{verify}{address}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{verify}{address}
|
||||
Check the validity of an address on this server using SMTP \samp{VRFY}.
|
||||
Returns a tuple consisting of code 250 and a full \rfc{822} address
|
||||
(including human name) if the user address is valid. Otherwise returns
|
||||
|
@ -172,7 +195,7 @@ an SMTP error code of 400 or greater and an error string.
|
|||
\note{Many sites disable SMTP \samp{VRFY} in order to foil spammers.}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{login}{user, password}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{login}{user, password}
|
||||
Log in on an SMTP server that requires authentication.
|
||||
The arguments are the username and the password to authenticate with.
|
||||
If there has been no previous \samp{EHLO} or \samp{HELO} command this
|
||||
|
@ -190,7 +213,7 @@ or may raise the following exceptions:
|
|||
\end{description}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{starttls}{\optional{keyfile\optional{, certfile}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{starttls}{\optional{keyfile\optional{, certfile}}}
|
||||
Put the SMTP connection in TLS (Transport Layer Security) mode. All
|
||||
SMTP commands that follow will be encrypted. You should then call
|
||||
\method{ehlo()} again.
|
||||
|
@ -199,8 +222,8 @@ If \var{keyfile} and \var{certfile} are provided, these are passed to
|
|||
the \refmodule{socket} module's \function{ssl()} function.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{sendmail}{from_addr, to_addrs, msg\optional{,
|
||||
mail_options, rcpt_options}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{sendmail}{from_addr, to_addrs, msg\optional{,
|
||||
mail_options, rcpt_options}}
|
||||
Send mail. The required arguments are an \rfc{822} from-address
|
||||
string, a list of \rfc{822} to-address strings (a bare string will be
|
||||
treated as a list with 1 address), and a message string. The caller
|
||||
|
@ -256,7 +279,7 @@ an exception is raised.
|
|||
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{quit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SMTP]{quit}{}
|
||||
Terminate the SMTP session and close the connection.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ For an introduction to socket programming (in C), see the following
|
|||
papers: \citetitle{An Introductory 4.3BSD Interprocess Communication
|
||||
Tutorial}, by Stuart Sechrest and \citetitle{An Advanced 4.3BSD
|
||||
Interprocess Communication Tutorial}, by Samuel J. Leffler et al,
|
||||
both in the \citetitle{\UNIX{} Programmer's Manual, Supplementary Documents 1}
|
||||
both in the \citetitle{UNIX Programmer's Manual, Supplementary Documents 1}
|
||||
(sections PS1:7 and PS1:8). The platform-specific reference material
|
||||
for the various socket-related system calls are also a valuable source
|
||||
of information on the details of socket semantics. For \UNIX, refer
|
||||
|
@ -170,6 +170,15 @@ supported on this platform.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{create_connection}{address\optional{, timeout}}
|
||||
Connects to the \var{address} received (as usual, a \code{(host, port)}
|
||||
pair), with an optional timeout for the connection. Specially useful for
|
||||
higher-level protocols, it is not normally used directly from
|
||||
application-level code. Passing the optional \var{timeout} parameter
|
||||
will set the timeout on the socket instance (if it is not given or
|
||||
\code{None}, the global default timeout setting is used).
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{getaddrinfo}{host, port\optional{, family\optional{,
|
||||
socktype\optional{, proto\optional{,
|
||||
flags}}}}}
|
||||
|
@ -548,7 +557,7 @@ are described in \ref{bltin-file-objects}, ``File Objects.'')
|
|||
The file object references a \cfunction{dup()}ped version of the
|
||||
socket file descriptor, so the file object and socket object may be
|
||||
closed or garbage-collected independently.
|
||||
The socket must be in blocking mode.
|
||||
The socket must be in blocking mode (it can not have a timeout).
|
||||
\index{I/O control!buffering}The optional \var{mode}
|
||||
and \var{bufsize} arguments are interpreted the same way as by the
|
||||
built-in \function{file()} function; see ``Built-in Functions''
|
||||
|
@ -584,6 +593,7 @@ sending the data. See the \UNIX{} manual page
|
|||
\manpage{recv}{2} for the meaning of the optional argument
|
||||
\var{flags}; it defaults to zero. (The format of \var{address}
|
||||
depends on the address family --- see above.)
|
||||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[socket]{recv_into}{buffer\optional{, nbytes\optional{, flags}}}
|
||||
|
@ -593,6 +603,7 @@ If \var{nbytes} is not specified (or 0),
|
|||
receive up to the size available in the given buffer.
|
||||
See the \UNIX{} manual page \manpage{recv}{2} for the meaning of the
|
||||
optional argument \var{flags}; it defaults to zero.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[socket]{send}{string\optional{, flags}}
|
||||
|
@ -722,23 +733,23 @@ The socket protocol.
|
|||
|
||||
SSL objects have the following methods.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write}{s}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SSL]{write}{s}
|
||||
Writes the string \var{s} to the on the object's SSL connection.
|
||||
The return value is the number of bytes written.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read}{\optional{n}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SSL]{read}{\optional{n}}
|
||||
If \var{n} is provided, read \var{n} bytes from the SSL connection, otherwise
|
||||
read until EOF. The return value is a string of the bytes read.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{server}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SSL]{server}{}
|
||||
Returns a string describing the server's certificate.
|
||||
Useful for debugging purposes; do not parse the content of this string
|
||||
because its format can't be parsed unambiguously.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{issuer}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[SSL]{issuer}{}
|
||||
Returns a string describing the issuer of the server's certificate.
|
||||
Useful for debugging purposes; do not parse the content of this string
|
||||
because its format can't be parsed unambiguously.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -210,37 +210,37 @@ the feature again.
|
|||
A \class{Connection} instance has the following attributes and methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\label{sqlite3-Connection-IsolationLevel}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{isolation_level}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Connection]{isolation_level}
|
||||
Get or set the current isolation level. None for autocommit mode or one of
|
||||
"DEFERRED", "IMMEDIATE" or "EXLUSIVE". See ``Controlling Transactions'',
|
||||
section~\ref{sqlite3-Controlling-Transactions}, for a more detailed explanation.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{cursor}{\optional{cursorClass}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{cursor}{\optional{cursorClass}}
|
||||
The cursor method accepts a single optional parameter \var{cursorClass}.
|
||||
If supplied, this must be a custom cursor class that extends
|
||||
\class{sqlite3.Cursor}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{execute}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{execute}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
This is a nonstandard shortcut that creates an intermediate cursor object by
|
||||
calling the cursor method, then calls the cursor's \method{execute} method with the
|
||||
parameters given.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{executemany}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{executemany}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
This is a nonstandard shortcut that creates an intermediate cursor object by
|
||||
calling the cursor method, then calls the cursor's \method{executemany} method with the
|
||||
parameters given.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{executescript}{sql_script}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{executescript}{sql_script}
|
||||
This is a nonstandard shortcut that creates an intermediate cursor object by
|
||||
calling the cursor method, then calls the cursor's \method{executescript} method with the
|
||||
parameters given.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{create_function}{name, num_params, func}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{create_function}{name, num_params, func}
|
||||
|
||||
Creates a user-defined function that you can later use from within SQL
|
||||
statements under the function name \var{name}. \var{num_params} is the number
|
||||
|
@ -255,7 +255,7 @@ Example:
|
|||
\verbatiminput{sqlite3/md5func.py}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{create_aggregate}{name, num_params, aggregate_class}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{create_aggregate}{name, num_params, aggregate_class}
|
||||
|
||||
Creates a user-defined aggregate function.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -271,7 +271,7 @@ Example:
|
|||
\verbatiminput{sqlite3/mysumaggr.py}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{create_collation}{name, callable}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{create_collation}{name, callable}
|
||||
|
||||
Creates a collation with the specified \var{name} and \var{callable}. The
|
||||
callable will be passed two string arguments. It should return -1 if the first
|
||||
|
@ -293,14 +293,14 @@ To remove a collation, call \code{create_collation} with None as callable:
|
|||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{interrupt}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{interrupt}{}
|
||||
|
||||
You can call this method from a different thread to abort any queries that
|
||||
might be executing on the connection. The query will then abort and the caller
|
||||
will get an exception.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_authorizer}{authorizer_callback}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Connection]{set_authorizer}{authorizer_callback}
|
||||
|
||||
This routine registers a callback. The callback is invoked for each attempt to
|
||||
access a column of a table in the database. The callback should return
|
||||
|
@ -322,7 +322,7 @@ first one. All necessary constants are available in the \module{sqlite3}
|
|||
module.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{row_factory}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Connection]{row_factory}
|
||||
You can change this attribute to a callable that accepts the cursor and
|
||||
the original row as a tuple and will return the real result row. This
|
||||
way, you can implement more advanced ways of returning results, such
|
||||
|
@ -341,7 +341,7 @@ module.
|
|||
% XXX what's a db_row-based solution?
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{text_factory}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Connection]{text_factory}
|
||||
Using this attribute you can control what objects are returned for the
|
||||
TEXT data type. By default, this attribute is set to \class{unicode} and
|
||||
the \module{sqlite3} module will return Unicode objects for TEXT. If you want to return
|
||||
|
@ -359,7 +359,7 @@ module.
|
|||
\verbatiminput{sqlite3/text_factory.py}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{total_changes}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Connection]{total_changes}
|
||||
Returns the total number of database rows that have been modified, inserted,
|
||||
or deleted since the database connection was opened.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
@ -372,7 +372,7 @@ module.
|
|||
|
||||
A \class{Cursor} instance has the following attributes and methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{execute}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cursor]{execute}{sql, \optional{parameters}}
|
||||
|
||||
Executes a SQL statement. The SQL statement may be parametrized (i. e.
|
||||
placeholders instead of SQL literals). The \module{sqlite3} module supports two kinds of
|
||||
|
@ -394,7 +394,7 @@ This example shows how to use the named style:
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{executemany}{sql, seq_of_parameters}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cursor]{executemany}{sql, seq_of_parameters}
|
||||
Executes a SQL command against all parameter sequences or mappings found in the
|
||||
sequence \var{sql}. The \module{sqlite3} module also allows
|
||||
using an iterator yielding parameters instead of a sequence.
|
||||
|
@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ Here's a shorter example using a generator:
|
|||
\verbatiminput{sqlite3/executemany_2.py}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{executescript}{sql_script}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Cursor]{executescript}{sql_script}
|
||||
|
||||
This is a nonstandard convenience method for executing multiple SQL statements
|
||||
at once. It issues a COMMIT statement first, then executes the SQL script it
|
||||
|
@ -419,7 +419,7 @@ Example:
|
|||
\verbatiminput{sqlite3/executescript.py}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{rowcount}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Cursor]{rowcount}
|
||||
Although the \class{Cursor} class of the \module{sqlite3} module implements this
|
||||
attribute, the database engine's own support for the determination of "rows
|
||||
affected"/"rows selected" is quirky.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -559,25 +559,25 @@ linear concatenation performance across versions and implementations.
|
|||
These are the string methods which both 8-bit strings and Unicode
|
||||
objects support:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{capitalize}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{capitalize}{}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with only its first character capitalized.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{center}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{center}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
Return centered in a string of length \var{width}. Padding is done
|
||||
using the specified \var{fillchar} (default is a space).
|
||||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{fillchar} argument]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{count}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{count}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Return the number of occurrences of substring \var{sub} in string
|
||||
S\code{[\var{start}:\var{end}]}. Optional arguments \var{start} and
|
||||
\var{end} are interpreted as in slice notation.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{decode}{\optional{encoding\optional{, errors}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{decode}{\optional{encoding\optional{, errors}}}
|
||||
Decodes the string using the codec registered for \var{encoding}.
|
||||
\var{encoding} defaults to the default string encoding. \var{errors}
|
||||
may be given to set a different error handling scheme. The default is
|
||||
|
@ -589,7 +589,7 @@ may be given to set a different error handling scheme. The default is
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for other error handling schemes added]{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{encode}{\optional{encoding\optional{,errors}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{encode}{\optional{encoding\optional{,errors}}}
|
||||
Return an encoded version of the string. Default encoding is the current
|
||||
default string encoding. \var{errors} may be given to set a different
|
||||
error handling scheme. The default for \var{errors} is
|
||||
|
@ -604,7 +604,7 @@ For a list of possible encodings, see section~\ref{standard-encodings}.
|
|||
\code{'backslashreplace'} and other error handling schemes added]{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{endswith}{suffix\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{endswith}{suffix\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if the string ends with the specified \var{suffix},
|
||||
otherwise return \code{False}. \var{suffix} can also be a tuple of
|
||||
suffixes to look for. With optional \var{start}, test beginning at
|
||||
|
@ -613,13 +613,13 @@ that position. With optional \var{end}, stop comparing at that position.
|
|||
\versionchanged[Accept tuples as \var{suffix}]{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{expandtabs}{\optional{tabsize}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{expandtabs}{\optional{tabsize}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string where all tab characters are expanded
|
||||
using spaces. If \var{tabsize} is not given, a tab size of \code{8}
|
||||
characters is assumed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{find}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{find}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Return the lowest index in the string where substring \var{sub} is
|
||||
found, such that \var{sub} is contained in the range [\var{start},
|
||||
\var{end}]. Optional arguments \var{start} and \var{end} are
|
||||
|
@ -627,47 +627,47 @@ interpreted as in slice notation. Return \code{-1} if \var{sub} is
|
|||
not found.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{index}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{index}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Like \method{find()}, but raise \exception{ValueError} when the
|
||||
substring is not found.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{isalnum}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{isalnum}{}
|
||||
Return true if all characters in the string are alphanumeric and there
|
||||
is at least one character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{isalpha}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{isalpha}{}
|
||||
Return true if all characters in the string are alphabetic and there
|
||||
is at least one character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{isdigit}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{isdigit}{}
|
||||
Return true if all characters in the string are digits and there
|
||||
is at least one character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{islower}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{islower}{}
|
||||
Return true if all cased characters in the string are lowercase and
|
||||
there is at least one cased character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{isspace}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{isspace}{}
|
||||
Return true if there are only whitespace characters in the string and
|
||||
there is at least one character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{istitle}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{istitle}{}
|
||||
Return true if the string is a titlecased string and there is at least one
|
||||
character, for example uppercase characters may only follow uncased
|
||||
characters and lowercase characters only cased ones. Return false
|
||||
|
@ -676,20 +676,20 @@ otherwise.
|
|||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{isupper}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{isupper}{}
|
||||
Return true if all cased characters in the string are uppercase and
|
||||
there is at least one cased character, false otherwise.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{join}{seq}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{join}{seq}
|
||||
Return a string which is the concatenation of the strings in the
|
||||
sequence \var{seq}. The separator between elements is the string
|
||||
providing this method.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{ljust}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{ljust}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
Return the string left justified in a string of length \var{width}.
|
||||
Padding is done using the specified \var{fillchar} (default is a
|
||||
space). The original string is returned if
|
||||
|
@ -697,13 +697,13 @@ space). The original string is returned if
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{fillchar} argument]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{lower}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{lower}{}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string converted to lowercase.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{lstrip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{lstrip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with leading characters removed. The
|
||||
\var{chars} argument is a string specifying the set of characters
|
||||
to be removed. If omitted or \code{None}, the \var{chars} argument
|
||||
|
@ -718,7 +718,7 @@ a prefix; rather, all combinations of its values are stripped:
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{chars} argument]{2.2.2}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{partition}{sep}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{partition}{sep}
|
||||
Split the string at the first occurrence of \var{sep}, and return
|
||||
a 3-tuple containing the part before the separator, the separator
|
||||
itself, and the part after the separator. If the separator is not
|
||||
|
@ -727,26 +727,26 @@ two empty strings.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{replace}{old, new\optional{, count}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{replace}{old, new\optional{, count}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with all occurrences of substring
|
||||
\var{old} replaced by \var{new}. If the optional argument
|
||||
\var{count} is given, only the first \var{count} occurrences are
|
||||
replaced.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rfind}{sub \optional{,start \optional{,end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rfind}{sub \optional{,start \optional{,end}}}
|
||||
Return the highest index in the string where substring \var{sub} is
|
||||
found, such that \var{sub} is contained within s[start,end]. Optional
|
||||
arguments \var{start} and \var{end} are interpreted as in slice
|
||||
notation. Return \code{-1} on failure.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rindex}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rindex}{sub\optional{, start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Like \method{rfind()} but raises \exception{ValueError} when the
|
||||
substring \var{sub} is not found.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rjust}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rjust}{width\optional{, fillchar}}
|
||||
Return the string right justified in a string of length \var{width}.
|
||||
Padding is done using the specified \var{fillchar} (default is a space).
|
||||
The original string is returned if
|
||||
|
@ -754,7 +754,7 @@ The original string is returned if
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{fillchar} argument]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rpartition}{sep}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rpartition}{sep}
|
||||
Split the string at the last occurrence of \var{sep}, and return
|
||||
a 3-tuple containing the part before the separator, the separator
|
||||
itself, and the part after the separator. If the separator is not
|
||||
|
@ -763,7 +763,7 @@ the string itself.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rsplit}{\optional{sep \optional{,maxsplit}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rsplit}{\optional{sep \optional{,maxsplit}}}
|
||||
Return a list of the words in the string, using \var{sep} as the
|
||||
delimiter string. If \var{maxsplit} is given, at most \var{maxsplit}
|
||||
splits are done, the \emph{rightmost} ones. If \var{sep} is not specified
|
||||
|
@ -773,7 +773,7 @@ is described in detail below.
|
|||
\versionadded{2.4}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{rstrip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{rstrip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with trailing characters removed. The
|
||||
\var{chars} argument is a string specifying the set of characters
|
||||
to be removed. If omitted or \code{None}, the \var{chars} argument
|
||||
|
@ -788,7 +788,7 @@ a suffix; rather, all combinations of its values are stripped:
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{chars} argument]{2.2.2}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{split}{\optional{sep \optional{,maxsplit}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{split}{\optional{sep \optional{,maxsplit}}}
|
||||
Return a list of the words in the string, using \var{sep} as the
|
||||
delimiter string. If \var{maxsplit} is given, at most \var{maxsplit}
|
||||
splits are done. (thus, the list will have at most \code{\var{maxsplit}+1}
|
||||
|
@ -811,13 +811,13 @@ Splitting an empty string or a string consisting of just whitespace
|
|||
returns an empty list.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{splitlines}{\optional{keepends}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{splitlines}{\optional{keepends}}
|
||||
Return a list of the lines in the string, breaking at line
|
||||
boundaries. Line breaks are not included in the resulting list unless
|
||||
\var{keepends} is given and true.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{startswith}{prefix\optional{,
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{startswith}{prefix\optional{,
|
||||
start\optional{, end}}}
|
||||
Return \code{True} if string starts with the \var{prefix}, otherwise
|
||||
return \code{False}. \var{prefix} can also be a tuple of
|
||||
|
@ -828,7 +828,7 @@ position.
|
|||
\versionchanged[Accept tuples as \var{prefix}]{2.5}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{strip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{strip}{\optional{chars}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with the leading and trailing characters
|
||||
removed. The \var{chars} argument is a string specifying the set of
|
||||
characters to be removed. If omitted or \code{None}, the \var{chars}
|
||||
|
@ -843,21 +843,21 @@ a prefix or suffix; rather, all combinations of its values are stripped:
|
|||
\versionchanged[Support for the \var{chars} argument]{2.2.2}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{swapcase}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{swapcase}{}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string with uppercase characters converted to
|
||||
lowercase and vice versa.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{title}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{title}{}
|
||||
Return a titlecased version of the string: words start with uppercase
|
||||
characters, all remaining cased characters are lowercase.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{translate}{table\optional{, deletechars}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{translate}{table\optional{, deletechars}}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string where all characters occurring in the
|
||||
optional argument \var{deletechars} are removed, and the remaining
|
||||
characters have been mapped through the given translation table, which
|
||||
|
@ -865,6 +865,13 @@ must be a string of length 256.
|
|||
|
||||
You can use the \function{maketrans()} helper function in the
|
||||
\refmodule{string} module to create a translation table.
|
||||
For string objects, set the \var{table} argument to \code{None}
|
||||
for translations that only delete characters:
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
>>> 'read this short text'.translate(None, 'aeiou')
|
||||
'rd ths shrt txt'
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
\versionadded[Support for a \code{None} \var{table} argument]{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
For Unicode objects, the \method{translate()} method does not
|
||||
accept the optional \var{deletechars} argument. Instead, it
|
||||
|
@ -877,13 +884,13 @@ character mapping codec using the \refmodule{codecs} module (see
|
|||
\module{encodings.cp1251} for an example).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{upper}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{upper}{}
|
||||
Return a copy of the string converted to uppercase.
|
||||
|
||||
For 8-bit strings, this method is locale-dependent.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[string]{zfill}{width}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[str]{zfill}{width}
|
||||
Return the numeric string left filled with zeros in a string
|
||||
of length \var{width}. The original string is returned if
|
||||
\var{width} is less than \code{len(\var{s})}.
|
||||
|
@ -1592,14 +1599,15 @@ A file object is its own iterator, for example \code{iter(\var{f})} returns
|
|||
iterator, typically in a \keyword{for} loop (for example,
|
||||
\code{for line in f: print line}), the \method{__next__()} method is
|
||||
called repeatedly. This method returns the next input line, or raises
|
||||
\exception{StopIteration} when \EOF{} is hit. In order to make a
|
||||
\keyword{for} loop the most efficient way of looping over the lines of
|
||||
a file (a very common operation), the \method{__next__()} method uses a
|
||||
hidden read-ahead buffer. As a consequence of using a read-ahead
|
||||
buffer, combining \method{__next__()} with other file methods (like
|
||||
\method{readline()}) does not work right. However, using
|
||||
\method{seek()} to reposition the file to an absolute position will
|
||||
flush the read-ahead buffer.
|
||||
\exception{StopIteration} when \EOF{} is hit when the file is open for
|
||||
reading (behavior is undefined when the file is open for writing). In
|
||||
order to make a \keyword{for} loop the most efficient way of looping
|
||||
over the lines of a file (a very common operation), the
|
||||
\method{__next__()} method uses a hidden read-ahead buffer. As a
|
||||
consequence of using a read-ahead buffer, combining \method{__next__()}
|
||||
with other file methods (like \method{readline()}) does not work
|
||||
right. However, using \method{seek()} to reposition the file to an
|
||||
absolute position will flush the read-ahead buffer.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -419,7 +419,8 @@ parameter cannot be passed in earlier 2.2 versions]{2.2.3}
|
|||
Delete all characters from \var{s} that are in \var{deletechars} (if
|
||||
present), and then translate the characters using \var{table}, which
|
||||
must be a 256-character string giving the translation for each
|
||||
character value, indexed by its ordinal.
|
||||
character value, indexed by its ordinal. If \var{table} is \code{None},
|
||||
then only the character deletion step is performed.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{upper}{s}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -176,16 +176,16 @@ metacharacters, can safely be passed to child processes.
|
|||
|
||||
Instances of the \class{Popen} class have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{poll}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Popen]{poll}{}
|
||||
Check if child process has terminated. Returns returncode
|
||||
attribute.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{wait}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Popen]{wait}{}
|
||||
Wait for child process to terminate. Returns returncode attribute.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{communicate}{input=None}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Popen]{communicate}{input=None}
|
||||
Interact with process: Send data to stdin. Read data from stdout and
|
||||
stderr, until end-of-file is reached. Wait for process to terminate.
|
||||
The optional \var{input} argument should be a string to be sent to the
|
||||
|
@ -199,29 +199,29 @@ if the data size is large or unlimited.}
|
|||
|
||||
The following attributes are also available:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{stdin}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen]{stdin}
|
||||
If the \var{stdin} argument is \code{PIPE}, this attribute is a file
|
||||
object that provides input to the child process. Otherwise, it is
|
||||
\code{None}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{stdout}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen]{stdout}
|
||||
If the \var{stdout} argument is \code{PIPE}, this attribute is a file
|
||||
object that provides output from the child process. Otherwise, it is
|
||||
\code{None}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{stderr}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen]{stderr}
|
||||
If the \var{stderr} argument is \code{PIPE}, this attribute is file
|
||||
object that provides error output from the child process. Otherwise,
|
||||
it is \code{None}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{pid}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen]{pid}
|
||||
The process ID of the child process.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{returncode}
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}[Popen]{returncode}
|
||||
The child return code. A \code{None} value indicates that the process
|
||||
hasn't terminated yet. A negative value -N indicates that the child
|
||||
was terminated by signal N (\UNIX{} only).
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -3,3 +3,5 @@
|
|||
|
||||
The modules described in this chapter provide interfaces to features
|
||||
that are unique to SunOS 5 (also known as Solaris version 2).
|
||||
|
||||
\localmoduletable
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -15,8 +15,8 @@ It is always available.
|
|||
whether this is a full pathname or not). If the command was
|
||||
executed using the \programopt{-c} command line option to the
|
||||
interpreter, \code{argv[0]} is set to the string \code{'-c'}. If no
|
||||
script name was passed to the Python interpreter, \code{argv} has
|
||||
zero length.
|
||||
script name was passed to the Python interpreter, \code{argv[0]} is
|
||||
the empty string.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{byteorder}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -12,21 +12,24 @@ Some facts and figures:
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{itemize}
|
||||
\item reads and writes \module{gzip} and \module{bzip2} compressed archives.
|
||||
\item creates \POSIX{} 1003.1-1990 compliant or GNU tar compatible archives.
|
||||
\item reads GNU tar extensions \emph{longname}, \emph{longlink} and
|
||||
\emph{sparse}.
|
||||
\item stores pathnames of unlimited length using GNU tar extensions.
|
||||
\item read/write support for the \POSIX{}.1-1988 (ustar) format.
|
||||
\item read/write support for the GNU tar format including \emph{longname} and
|
||||
\emph{longlink} extensions, read-only support for the \emph{sparse}
|
||||
extension.
|
||||
\item read/write support for the \POSIX{}.1-2001 (pax) format.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\item handles directories, regular files, hardlinks, symbolic links, fifos,
|
||||
character devices and block devices and is able to acquire and
|
||||
restore file information like timestamp, access permissions and owner.
|
||||
\item can handle tape devices.
|
||||
\end{itemize}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{open}{\optional{name\optional{, mode
|
||||
\optional{, fileobj\optional{, bufsize}}}}}
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{open}{name\optional{, mode\optional{,
|
||||
fileobj\optional{, bufsize}}}, **kwargs}
|
||||
Return a \class{TarFile} object for the pathname \var{name}.
|
||||
For detailed information on \class{TarFile} objects,
|
||||
see \citetitle{TarFile Objects} (section \ref{tarfile-objects}).
|
||||
For detailed information on \class{TarFile} objects and the keyword
|
||||
arguments that are allowed, see \citetitle{TarFile Objects}
|
||||
(section \ref{tarfile-objects}).
|
||||
|
||||
\var{mode} has to be a string of the form \code{'filemode[:compression]'},
|
||||
it defaults to \code{'r'}. Here is a full list of mode combinations:
|
||||
|
@ -130,6 +133,31 @@ Some facts and figures:
|
|||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{excdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{USTAR_FORMAT}
|
||||
\POSIX{}.1-1988 (ustar) format. It supports filenames up to a length of
|
||||
at best 256 characters and linknames up to 100 characters. The maximum
|
||||
file size is 8 gigabytes. This is an old and limited but widely
|
||||
supported format.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{GNU_FORMAT}
|
||||
GNU tar format. It supports arbitrarily long filenames and linknames and
|
||||
files bigger than 8 gigabytes. It is the defacto standard on GNU/Linux
|
||||
systems.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{PAX_FORMAT}
|
||||
\POSIX{}.1-2001 (pax) format. It is the most flexible format with
|
||||
virtually no limits. It supports long filenames and linknames, large files
|
||||
and stores pathnames in a portable way. However, not all tar
|
||||
implementations today are able to handle pax archives properly.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{datadesc}{DEFAULT_FORMAT}
|
||||
The default format for creating archives. This is currently
|
||||
\constant{GNU_FORMAT}.
|
||||
\end{datadesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{seealso}
|
||||
\seemodule{zipfile}{Documentation of the \refmodule{zipfile}
|
||||
standard module.}
|
||||
|
@ -152,12 +180,21 @@ tar archive several times. Each archive member is represented by a
|
|||
\class{TarInfo} object, see \citetitle{TarInfo Objects} (section
|
||||
\ref{tarinfo-objects}) for details.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{TarFile}{\optional{name
|
||||
\optional{, mode\optional{, fileobj}}}}
|
||||
Open an \emph{(uncompressed)} tar archive \var{name}.
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{TarFile}{name=None, mode='r', fileobj=None,
|
||||
format=DEFAULT_FORMAT, tarinfo=TarInfo, dereference=False,
|
||||
ignore_zeros=False, encoding=None, pax_headers=None, debug=0,
|
||||
errorlevel=0}
|
||||
|
||||
All following arguments are optional and can be accessed as instance
|
||||
attributes as well.
|
||||
|
||||
\var{name} is the pathname of the archive. It can be omitted if
|
||||
\var{fileobj} is given. In this case, the file object's \member{name}
|
||||
attribute is used if it exists.
|
||||
|
||||
\var{mode} is either \code{'r'} to read from an existing archive,
|
||||
\code{'a'} to append data to an existing file or \code{'w'} to create a new
|
||||
file overwriting an existing one. \var{mode} defaults to \code{'r'}.
|
||||
file overwriting an existing one.
|
||||
|
||||
If \var{fileobj} is given, it is used for reading or writing data.
|
||||
If it can be determined, \var{mode} is overridden by \var{fileobj}'s mode.
|
||||
|
@ -165,6 +202,48 @@ tar archive several times. Each archive member is represented by a
|
|||
\begin{notice}
|
||||
\var{fileobj} is not closed, when \class{TarFile} is closed.
|
||||
\end{notice}
|
||||
|
||||
\var{format} controls the archive format. It must be one of the constants
|
||||
\constant{USTAR_FORMAT}, \constant{GNU_FORMAT} or \constant{PAX_FORMAT}
|
||||
that are defined at module level.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{tarinfo} argument can be used to replace the default
|
||||
\class{TarInfo} class with a different one.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
If \var{dereference} is \code{False}, add symbolic and hard links to the
|
||||
archive. If it is \code{True}, add the content of the target files to the
|
||||
archive. This has no effect on systems that do not support symbolic links.
|
||||
|
||||
If \var{ignore_zeros} is \code{False}, treat an empty block as the end of
|
||||
the archive. If it is \var{True}, skip empty (and invalid) blocks and try
|
||||
to get as many members as possible. This is only useful for reading
|
||||
concatenated or damaged archives.
|
||||
|
||||
\var{debug} can be set from \code{0} (no debug messages) up to \code{3}
|
||||
(all debug messages). The messages are written to \code{sys.stderr}.
|
||||
|
||||
If \var{errorlevel} is \code{0}, all errors are ignored when using
|
||||
\method{extract()}. Nevertheless, they appear as error messages in the
|
||||
debug output, when debugging is enabled. If \code{1}, all \emph{fatal}
|
||||
errors are raised as \exception{OSError} or \exception{IOError} exceptions.
|
||||
If \code{2}, all \emph{non-fatal} errors are raised as \exception{TarError}
|
||||
exceptions as well.
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{encoding} argument defines the local character encoding. It
|
||||
defaults to the value from \function{sys.getfilesystemencoding()} or if
|
||||
that is \code{None} to \code{"ascii"}. \var{encoding} is used only in
|
||||
connection with the pax format which stores text data in \emph{UTF-8}. If
|
||||
it is not set correctly, character conversion will fail with a
|
||||
\exception{UnicodeError}.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{pax_headers} argument must be a dictionary whose elements are
|
||||
either unicode objects, numbers or strings that can be decoded to unicode
|
||||
using \var{encoding}. This information will be added to the archive as a
|
||||
pax global header.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{open}{...}
|
||||
|
@ -279,43 +358,11 @@ tar archive several times. Each archive member is represented by a
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{posix}
|
||||
If true, create a \POSIX{} 1003.1-1990 compliant archive. GNU
|
||||
extensions are not used, because they are not part of the \POSIX{}
|
||||
standard. This limits the length of filenames to at most 256,
|
||||
link names to 100 characters and the maximum file size to 8
|
||||
gigabytes. A \exception{ValueError} is raised if a file exceeds
|
||||
this limit. If false, create a GNU tar compatible archive. It
|
||||
will not be \POSIX{} compliant, but can store files without any
|
||||
of the above restrictions.
|
||||
Setting this to \constant{True} is equivalent to setting the
|
||||
\member{format} attribute to \constant{USTAR_FORMAT},
|
||||
\constant{False} is equivalent to \constant{GNU_FORMAT}.
|
||||
\versionchanged[\var{posix} defaults to \constant{False}]{2.4}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{dereference}
|
||||
If false, add symbolic and hard links to archive. If true, add the
|
||||
content of the target files to the archive. This has no effect on
|
||||
systems that do not support symbolic links.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{ignore_zeros}
|
||||
If false, treat an empty block as the end of the archive. If true,
|
||||
skip empty (and invalid) blocks and try to get as many members as
|
||||
possible. This is only useful for concatenated or damaged
|
||||
archives.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{debug=0}
|
||||
To be set from \code{0} (no debug messages; the default) up to
|
||||
\code{3} (all debug messages). The messages are written to
|
||||
\code{sys.stderr}.
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{errorlevel}
|
||||
If \code{0} (the default), all errors are ignored when using
|
||||
\method{extract()}. Nevertheless, they appear as error messages
|
||||
in the debug output, when debugging is enabled. If \code{1}, all
|
||||
\emph{fatal} errors are raised as \exception{OSError} or
|
||||
\exception{IOError} exceptions. If \code{2}, all \emph{non-fatal}
|
||||
errors are raised as \exception{TarError} exceptions as well.
|
||||
\deprecated{2.6}{Use the \member{format} attribute instead.}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
%-----------------
|
||||
|
@ -343,12 +390,16 @@ the file's data itself.
|
|||
invalid.]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{tobuf}{posix}
|
||||
Create a string buffer from a \class{TarInfo} object.
|
||||
See \class{TarFile}'s \member{posix} attribute for information
|
||||
on the \var{posix} argument. It defaults to \constant{False}.
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{fromtarfile}{tarfile}
|
||||
Read the next member from the \class{TarFile} object \var{tarfile} and
|
||||
return it as a \class{TarInfo} object.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\versionadded[The \var{posix} parameter]{2.5}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{tobuf}{\optional{format}}
|
||||
Create a string buffer from a \class{TarInfo} object. See
|
||||
\class{TarFile}'s \member{format} argument for information.
|
||||
\versionchanged[The \var{format} parameter]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
A \code{TarInfo} object has the following public data attributes:
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -23,13 +23,16 @@ Mark), BRK (Break), IP (Interrupt process), AO (Abort output), AYT
|
|||
SB (Subnegotiation Begin).
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{Telnet}{\optional{host\optional{, port}}}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{Telnet}{\optional{host\optional{, port\optional{, timeout}}}}
|
||||
\class{Telnet} represents a connection to a Telnet server. The
|
||||
instance is initially not connected by default; the \method{open()}
|
||||
method must be used to establish a connection. Alternatively, the
|
||||
host name and optional port number can be passed to the constructor,
|
||||
to, in which case the connection to the server will be established
|
||||
before the constructor returns.
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if not specified, or passed as None, the global default
|
||||
timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
|
||||
Do not reopen an already connected instance.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -52,7 +55,7 @@ individual descriptions below.
|
|||
\class{Telnet} instances have the following methods:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_until}{expected\optional{, timeout}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_until}{expected\optional{, timeout}}
|
||||
Read until a given string, \var{expected}, is encountered or until
|
||||
\var{timeout} seconds have passed.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -61,17 +64,17 @@ possibly the empty string. Raise \exception{EOFError} if the connection
|
|||
is closed and no cooked data is available.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_all}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_all}{}
|
||||
Read all data until \EOF; block until connection closed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_some}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_some}{}
|
||||
Read at least one byte of cooked data unless \EOF{} is hit.
|
||||
Return \code{''} if \EOF{} is hit. Block if no data is immediately
|
||||
available.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_very_eager}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_very_eager}{}
|
||||
Read everything that can be without blocking in I/O (eager).
|
||||
|
||||
Raise \exception{EOFError} if connection closed and no cooked data
|
||||
|
@ -79,7 +82,7 @@ available. Return \code{''} if no cooked data available otherwise.
|
|||
Do not block unless in the midst of an IAC sequence.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_eager}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_eager}{}
|
||||
Read readily available data.
|
||||
|
||||
Raise \exception{EOFError} if connection closed and no cooked data
|
||||
|
@ -87,7 +90,7 @@ available. Return \code{''} if no cooked data available otherwise.
|
|||
Do not block unless in the midst of an IAC sequence.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_lazy}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_lazy}{}
|
||||
Process and return data already in the queues (lazy).
|
||||
|
||||
Raise \exception{EOFError} if connection closed and no data available.
|
||||
|
@ -95,7 +98,7 @@ Return \code{''} if no cooked data available otherwise. Do not block
|
|||
unless in the midst of an IAC sequence.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_very_lazy}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_very_lazy}{}
|
||||
Return any data available in the cooked queue (very lazy).
|
||||
|
||||
Raise \exception{EOFError} if connection closed and no data available.
|
||||
|
@ -103,7 +106,7 @@ Return \code{''} if no cooked data available otherwise. This method
|
|||
never blocks.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{read_sb_data}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{read_sb_data}{}
|
||||
Return the data collected between a SB/SE pair (suboption begin/end).
|
||||
The callback should access these data when it was invoked with a
|
||||
\code{SE} command. This method never blocks.
|
||||
|
@ -111,52 +114,55 @@ The callback should access these data when it was invoked with a
|
|||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{open}{host\optional{, port}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{open}{host\optional{, port\optional{, timeout}}}
|
||||
Connect to a host.
|
||||
The optional second argument is the port number, which
|
||||
defaults to the standard Telnet port (23).
|
||||
The optional \var{timeout} parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
|
||||
connection attempt (if not specified, or passed as None, the global default
|
||||
timeout setting will be used).
|
||||
|
||||
Do not try to reopen an already connected instance.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{msg}{msg\optional{, *args}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{msg}{msg\optional{, *args}}
|
||||
Print a debug message when the debug level is \code{>} 0.
|
||||
If extra arguments are present, they are substituted in the
|
||||
message using the standard string formatting operator.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_debuglevel}{debuglevel}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{set_debuglevel}{debuglevel}
|
||||
Set the debug level. The higher the value of \var{debuglevel}, the
|
||||
more debug output you get (on \code{sys.stdout}).
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{close}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{close}{}
|
||||
Close the connection.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{get_socket}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{get_socket}{}
|
||||
Return the socket object used internally.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{fileno}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{fileno}{}
|
||||
Return the file descriptor of the socket object used internally.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{write}{buffer}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{write}{buffer}
|
||||
Write a string to the socket, doubling any IAC characters.
|
||||
This can block if the connection is blocked. May raise
|
||||
\exception{socket.error} if the connection is closed.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{interact}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{interact}{}
|
||||
Interaction function, emulates a very dumb Telnet client.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{mt_interact}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{mt_interact}{}
|
||||
Multithreaded version of \method{interact()}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{expect}{list\optional{, timeout}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{expect}{list\optional{, timeout}}
|
||||
Read until one from a list of a regular expressions matches.
|
||||
|
||||
The first argument is a list of regular expressions, either
|
||||
|
@ -178,7 +184,7 @@ or if more than one expression can match the same input, the
|
|||
results are indeterministic, and may depend on the I/O timing.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{set_option_negotiation_callback}{callback}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Telnet]{set_option_negotiation_callback}{callback}
|
||||
Each time a telnet option is read on the input flow, this
|
||||
\var{callback} (if set) is called with the following parameters :
|
||||
callback(telnet socket, command (DO/DONT/WILL/WONT), option). No other
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ The \var{dir}, \var{prefix} and \var{suffix} parameters are passed to
|
|||
\begin{funcdesc}{NamedTemporaryFile}{\optional{mode=\code{'w+b'}\optional{,
|
||||
bufsize=\code{-1}\optional{,
|
||||
suffix\optional{, prefix\optional{,
|
||||
dir}}}}}}
|
||||
dir\optional{, delete}}}}}}}
|
||||
This function operates exactly as \function{TemporaryFile()} does,
|
||||
except that the file is guaranteed to have a visible name in the file
|
||||
system (on \UNIX, the directory entry is not unlinked). That name can
|
||||
|
@ -61,7 +61,27 @@ be retrieved from the \member{name} member of the file object. Whether
|
|||
the name can be used to open the file a second time, while the
|
||||
named temporary file is still open, varies across platforms (it can
|
||||
be so used on \UNIX; it cannot on Windows NT or later).
|
||||
If \var{delete} is true (the default), the file is deleted as soon as
|
||||
it is closed.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.3}
|
||||
\versionadded[The \var{delete} parameter]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{SpooledTemporaryFile}{\optional{max\_size=\code{0},
|
||||
\optional{mode=\code{'w+b'}\optional{,
|
||||
bufsize=\code{-1}\optional{,
|
||||
suffix\optional{, prefix\optional{,
|
||||
dir}}}}}}}
|
||||
This function operates exactly as \function{TemporaryFile()} does,
|
||||
except that data is spooled in memory until the file size exceeds
|
||||
\var{max_size}, or until the file's \function{fileno()} method is
|
||||
called, at which point the contents are written to disk and operation
|
||||
proceeds as with \function{TemporaryFile()}.
|
||||
|
||||
The resulting file has one additional method, \function{rollover()},
|
||||
which causes the file to roll over to an on-disk file regardless of
|
||||
its size.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{mkstemp}{\optional{suffix\optional{,
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -14,11 +14,11 @@ your tests while \module{test.regrtest} drives the testing suite.
|
|||
|
||||
Each module in the \module{test} package whose name starts with
|
||||
\samp{test_} is a testing suite for a specific module or feature.
|
||||
All new tests should be written using the \refmodule{unittest} module;
|
||||
using \refmodule{unittest} is not required but makes the tests more
|
||||
flexible and maintenance of the tests easier. Some older tests are
|
||||
written to use \refmodule{doctest} and a ``traditional'' testing
|
||||
style; these styles of tests will not be covered.
|
||||
All new tests should be written using the \refmodule{unittest} or
|
||||
\refmodule{doctest} module. Some older tests are
|
||||
written using a ``traditional'' testing style that compares output
|
||||
printed to \code{sys.stdout}; this style of test is considered
|
||||
deprecated.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{seealso}
|
||||
\seemodule{unittest}{Writing PyUnit regression tests.}
|
||||
|
@ -29,8 +29,8 @@ style; these styles of tests will not be covered.
|
|||
\subsection{Writing Unit Tests for the \module{test} package%
|
||||
\label{writing-tests}}
|
||||
|
||||
It is preferred that tests for the \module{test} package use the
|
||||
\refmodule{unittest} module and follow a few guidelines.
|
||||
It is preferred that tests that use the \refmodule{unittest} module
|
||||
follow a few guidelines.
|
||||
One is to name the test module by starting it with \samp{test_} and end it with
|
||||
the name of the module being tested.
|
||||
The test methods in the test module should start with \samp{test_} and end with
|
||||
|
@ -196,7 +196,9 @@ regression tests.
|
|||
This module defines the following exceptions:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{excdesc}{TestFailed}
|
||||
Exception to be raised when a test fails.
|
||||
Exception to be raised when a test fails. This is deprecated in favor
|
||||
of \module{unittest}-based tests and \class{unittest.TestCase}'s
|
||||
assertion methods.
|
||||
\end{excdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{excdesc}{TestSkipped}
|
||||
|
@ -273,18 +275,30 @@ filter settings.
|
|||
Execute \class{unittest.TestCase} subclasses passed to the function.
|
||||
The function scans the classes for methods starting with the prefix
|
||||
\samp{test_} and executes the tests individually.
|
||||
This is the preferred way to execute tests.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{run_suite}{suite\optional{, testclass}}
|
||||
Execute the \class{unittest.TestSuite} instance \var{suite}.
|
||||
The optional argument \var{testclass} accepts one of the test classes in the
|
||||
suite so as to print out more detailed information on where the testing suite
|
||||
originated from.
|
||||
It is also legal to pass strings as parameters; these should be keys in
|
||||
\code{sys.modules}. Each associated module will be scanned by
|
||||
\code{unittest.TestLoader.loadTestsFromModule()}. This is usually seen in
|
||||
the following \function{test_main()} function:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
def test_main():
|
||||
test_support.run_unittest(__name__)
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
This will run all tests defined in the named module.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
The \module{test.test_support} module defines the following classes:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{TransientResource}{exc\optional{, **kwargs}}
|
||||
Create a context manager that raises \class{ResourceDenied} if the specified
|
||||
exception type is raised. Any keyword arguments are treated as name/value
|
||||
pairs to be compared against any exception raised with the \code{with}
|
||||
statement. Only if all pairs match is \class{ResourceDenied} raised.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{EnvironmentVarGuard}{}
|
||||
Class used to temporarily set or unset environment variables. Instances can be
|
||||
used as a context manager.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ edge of the display, while still presenting them in the source code
|
|||
in indented form.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that tabs and spaces are both treated as whitespace, but they are
|
||||
not equal: the lines \code{" {} hello"} and \code{"\textbackslash{}thello"}
|
||||
not equal: the lines \code{" {} hello"} and \code{"\e thello"}
|
||||
are considered to have no common leading whitespace. (This behaviour is
|
||||
new in Python 2.5; older versions of this module incorrectly expanded
|
||||
tabs before searching for common leading whitespace.)
|
||||
|
@ -115,6 +115,13 @@ replaced by a single space, which is \emph{not} the same as tab
|
|||
expansion.}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{drop_whitespace}
|
||||
(default: \code{True}) If true, whitespace that, after wrapping, happens
|
||||
to end up at the beginning or end of a line is dropped (leading whitespace
|
||||
in the first line is always preserved, though).
|
||||
\versionadded[Whitespace was always dropped in earlier versions]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{memberdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{memberdesc}{initial_indent}
|
||||
(default: \code{''}) String that will be prepended to the first line
|
||||
of wrapped output. Counts towards the length of the first line.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -15,17 +15,16 @@ situations where \module{threading} cannot be used because
|
|||
This module defines the following functions and objects:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{activeCount}{}
|
||||
Return the number of currently active \class{Thread} objects.
|
||||
The returned count is equal to the length of the list returned by
|
||||
Return the number of \class{Thread} objects currently alive. The
|
||||
returned count is equal to the length of the list returned by
|
||||
\function{enumerate()}.
|
||||
A function that returns the number of currently active threads.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{Condition}{}
|
||||
\begin{funcdescni}{Condition}{}
|
||||
A factory function that returns a new condition variable object.
|
||||
A condition variable allows one or more threads to wait until they
|
||||
are notified by another thread.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{funcdescni}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{currentThread}{}
|
||||
Return the current \class{Thread} object, corresponding to the
|
||||
|
@ -36,18 +35,18 @@ is returned.
|
|||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{enumerate}{}
|
||||
Return a list of all currently active \class{Thread} objects.
|
||||
The list includes daemonic threads, dummy thread objects created
|
||||
by \function{currentThread()}, and the main thread. It excludes terminated
|
||||
threads and threads that have not yet been started.
|
||||
Return a list of all \class{Thread} objects currently alive. The list
|
||||
includes daemonic threads, dummy thread objects created by
|
||||
\function{currentThread()}, and the main thread. It excludes
|
||||
terminated threads and threads that have not yet been started.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{Event}{}
|
||||
\begin{funcdescni}{Event}{}
|
||||
A factory function that returns a new event object. An event manages
|
||||
a flag that can be set to true with the \method{set()} method and
|
||||
reset to false with the \method{clear()} method. The \method{wait()}
|
||||
method blocks until the flag is true.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{funcdescni}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{local}{}
|
||||
A class that represents thread-local data. Thread-local data are data
|
||||
|
@ -82,14 +81,14 @@ acquire it again without blocking; the thread must release it once
|
|||
for each time it has acquired it.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{Semaphore}{\optional{value}}
|
||||
\begin{funcdescni}{Semaphore}{\optional{value}}
|
||||
A factory function that returns a new semaphore object. A
|
||||
semaphore manages a counter representing the number of \method{release()}
|
||||
calls minus the number of \method{acquire()} calls, plus an initial value.
|
||||
The \method{acquire()} method blocks if necessary until it can return
|
||||
without making the counter negative. If not given, \var{value} defaults to
|
||||
1.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
\end{funcdescni}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{BoundedSemaphore}{\optional{value}}
|
||||
A factory function that returns a new bounded semaphore object. A bounded
|
||||
|
@ -100,12 +99,12 @@ semaphore is released too many times it's a sign of a bug. If not given,
|
|||
\var{value} defaults to 1.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{Thread}{}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{Thread}
|
||||
A class that represents a thread of control. This class can be safely
|
||||
subclassed in a limited fashion.
|
||||
\end{classdesc*}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{Timer}{}
|
||||
\begin{classdesc*}{Timer}
|
||||
A thread that executes a function after a specified interval has passed.
|
||||
\end{classdesc*}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -183,7 +182,7 @@ and may vary across implementations.
|
|||
|
||||
All methods are executed atomically.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{acquire}{\optional{blocking\code{ = 1}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Lock]{acquire}{\optional{blocking\code{ = 1}}}
|
||||
Acquire a lock, blocking or non-blocking.
|
||||
|
||||
When invoked without arguments, block until the lock is
|
||||
|
@ -198,7 +197,7 @@ immediately; otherwise, do the same thing as when called
|
|||
without arguments, and return true.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{release}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Lock]{release}{}
|
||||
Release a lock.
|
||||
|
||||
When the lock is locked, reset it to unlocked, and return. If
|
||||
|
@ -228,7 +227,7 @@ the final \method{release()} (the \method{release()} of the outermost
|
|||
pair) resets the lock to unlocked and allows another thread blocked in
|
||||
\method{acquire()} to proceed.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{acquire}{\optional{blocking\code{ = 1}}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RLock]{acquire}{\optional{blocking\code{ = 1}}}
|
||||
Acquire a lock, blocking or non-blocking.
|
||||
|
||||
When invoked without arguments: if this thread already owns
|
||||
|
@ -250,7 +249,7 @@ immediately; otherwise, do the same thing as when called
|
|||
without arguments, and return true.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{release}{}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[RLock]{release}{}
|
||||
Release a lock, decrementing the recursion level. If after the
|
||||
decrement it is zero, reset the lock to unlocked (not owned by any
|
||||
thread), and if any other threads are blocked waiting for the lock to
|
||||
|
@ -526,12 +525,9 @@ calling the thread's \method{start()} method. This invokes the
|
|||
\method{run()} method in a separate thread of control.
|
||||
|
||||
Once the thread's activity is started, the thread is considered
|
||||
'alive' and 'active' (these concepts are almost, but not quite
|
||||
exactly, the same; their definition is intentionally somewhat
|
||||
vague). It stops being alive and active when its \method{run()}
|
||||
method terminates -- either normally, or by raising an unhandled
|
||||
exception. The \method{isAlive()} method tests whether the thread is
|
||||
alive.
|
||||
'alive'. It stops being alive when its \method{run()} method terminates
|
||||
-- either normally, or by raising an unhandled exception. The
|
||||
\method{isAlive()} method tests whether the thread is alive.
|
||||
|
||||
Other threads can call a thread's \method{join()} method. This blocks
|
||||
the calling thread until the thread whose \method{join()} method is
|
||||
|
@ -551,14 +547,13 @@ There is a ``main thread'' object; this corresponds to the
|
|||
initial thread of control in the Python program. It is not a
|
||||
daemon thread.
|
||||
|
||||
There is the possibility that ``dummy thread objects'' are
|
||||
created. These are thread objects corresponding to ``alien
|
||||
threads''. These are threads of control started outside the
|
||||
threading module, such as directly from C code. Dummy thread objects
|
||||
have limited functionality; they are always considered alive,
|
||||
active, and daemonic, and cannot be \method{join()}ed. They are never
|
||||
deleted, since it is impossible to detect the termination of alien
|
||||
threads.
|
||||
There is the possibility that ``dummy thread objects'' are created.
|
||||
These are thread objects corresponding to ``alien threads'', which
|
||||
are threads of control started outside the threading module, such as
|
||||
directly from C code. Dummy thread objects have limited
|
||||
functionality; they are always considered alive and daemonic, and
|
||||
cannot be \method{join()}ed. They are never deleted, since it is
|
||||
impossible to detect the termination of alien threads.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{classdesc}{Thread}{group=None, target=None, name=None,
|
||||
|
@ -646,7 +641,8 @@ name. The initial name is set by the constructor.
|
|||
Return whether the thread is alive.
|
||||
|
||||
Roughly, a thread is alive from the moment the \method{start()} method
|
||||
returns until its \method{run()} method terminates.
|
||||
returns until its \method{run()} method terminates. The module
|
||||
function \function{enumerate()} returns a list of all alive threads.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{isDaemon}{}
|
||||
|
@ -659,8 +655,8 @@ This must be called before \method{start()} is called.
|
|||
|
||||
The initial value is inherited from the creating thread.
|
||||
|
||||
The entire Python program exits when no active non-daemon
|
||||
threads are left.
|
||||
The entire Python program exits when no alive non-daemon threads are
|
||||
left.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -31,6 +31,13 @@ To measure the execution time of the first statement, use the
|
|||
\method{timeit()} method. The \method{repeat()} method is a
|
||||
convenience to call \method{timeit()} multiple times and return a list
|
||||
of results.
|
||||
|
||||
\versionchanged[The \var{stmt} and \var{setup} parameters can now also
|
||||
take objects that are callable without arguments. This
|
||||
will embed calls to them in a timer function that will
|
||||
then be executed by \method{timeit()}. Note that the timing
|
||||
overhead is a little larger in this case because of the
|
||||
extra function calls]{2.6}
|
||||
\end{classdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{print_exc}{\optional{file=\constant{None}}}
|
||||
|
@ -97,12 +104,30 @@ measured. If so, GC can be re-enabled as the first statement in the
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Starting with version 2.6, the module also defines two convenience functions:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{repeat}{stmt\optional{, setup\optional{, timer\optional{,
|
||||
repeat\code{=3} \optional{, number\code{=1000000}}}}}}
|
||||
Create a \class{Timer} instance with the given statement, setup code and timer
|
||||
function and run its \method{repeat} method with the given repeat count and
|
||||
\var{number} executions.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{timeit}{stmt\optional{, setup\optional{, timer\optional{,
|
||||
number\code{=1000000}}}}}
|
||||
Create a \class{Timer} instance with the given statement, setup code and timer
|
||||
function and run its \method{timeit} method with \var{number} executions.
|
||||
\versionadded{2.6}
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Command Line Interface}
|
||||
|
||||
When called as a program from the command line, the following form is used:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{verbatim}
|
||||
python timeit.py [-n N] [-r N] [-s S] [-t] [-c] [-h] [statement ...]
|
||||
python -m timeit [-n N] [-r N] [-s S] [-t] [-c] [-h] [statement ...]
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
where the following options are understood:
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -261,7 +261,7 @@ The only method which is more powerful as a method is
|
|||
\function{degrees()}, which takes an optional argument letting
|
||||
you specify the number of units corresponding to a full circle:
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}{degrees}{\optional{fullcircle}}
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[Turtle]{degrees}{\optional{fullcircle}}
|
||||
\var{fullcircle} is by default 360. This can cause the pen to have any
|
||||
angular units whatever: give \var{fullcircle} 2*$\pi$ for radians, or
|
||||
400 for gradians.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ specific class.
|
|||
\end{seealso}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
\subsection{Basic example \label{minimal-example}}
|
||||
\subsection{Basic example \label{unittest-minimal-example}}
|
||||
|
||||
The \module{unittest} module provides a rich set of tools for
|
||||
constructing and running tests. This section demonstrates that a
|
||||
|
@ -290,6 +290,7 @@ Often, many small test cases will use the same fixture. In this case,
|
|||
we would end up subclassing \class{SimpleWidgetTestCase} into many
|
||||
small one-method classes such as
|
||||
\class{DefaultWidgetSizeTestCase}. This is time-consuming and
|
||||
|
||||
discouraging, so in the same vein as JUnit, \module{unittest} provides
|
||||
a simpler mechanism:
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -540,7 +541,7 @@ easier.}
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{funcdesc}{main}{\optional{module\optional{,
|
||||
defaultTest\optional{, argv\optional{,
|
||||
testRunner\optional{, testRunner}}}}}}
|
||||
testRunner\optional{, testLoader}}}}}}
|
||||
A command-line program that runs a set of tests; this is primarily
|
||||
for making test modules conveniently executable. The simplest use
|
||||
for this function is to include the following line at the end of a
|
||||
|
@ -550,6 +551,9 @@ easier.}
|
|||
if __name__ == '__main__':
|
||||
unittest.main()
|
||||
\end{verbatim}
|
||||
|
||||
The \var{testRunner} argument can either be a test runner class or
|
||||
an already created instance of it.
|
||||
\end{funcdesc}
|
||||
|
||||
In some cases, the existing tests may have been written using the
|
||||
|
@ -615,14 +619,14 @@ The test code can use any of the following methods to check for and
|
|||
report failures.
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assert_}{expr\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline{failUnless}{expr\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failUnless}{expr\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
Signal a test failure if \var{expr} is false; the explanation for
|
||||
the error will be \var{msg} if given, otherwise it will be
|
||||
\constant{None}.
|
||||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assertEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline{failUnlessEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failUnlessEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
Test that \var{first} and \var{second} are equal. If the values do
|
||||
not compare equal, the test will fail with the explanation given by
|
||||
\var{msg}, or \constant{None}. Note that using \method{failUnlessEqual()}
|
||||
|
@ -633,7 +637,7 @@ report failures.
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assertNotEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline{failIfEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failIfEqual}{first, second\optional{, msg}}
|
||||
Test that \var{first} and \var{second} are not equal. If the values
|
||||
do compare equal, the test will fail with the explanation given by
|
||||
\var{msg}, or \constant{None}. Note that using \method{failIfEqual()}
|
||||
|
@ -645,7 +649,7 @@ report failures.
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assertAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
places\optional{, msg}}}
|
||||
\methodline{failUnlessAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failUnlessAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
places\optional{, msg}}}
|
||||
Test that \var{first} and \var{second} are approximately equal
|
||||
by computing the difference, rounding to the given number of \var{places},
|
||||
|
@ -657,7 +661,7 @@ report failures.
|
|||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assertNotAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
places\optional{, msg}}}
|
||||
\methodline{failIfAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failIfAlmostEqual}{first, second\optional{,
|
||||
places\optional{, msg}}}
|
||||
Test that \var{first} and \var{second} are not approximately equal
|
||||
by computing the difference, rounding to the given number of \var{places},
|
||||
|
@ -668,7 +672,7 @@ report failures.
|
|||
\end{methoddesc}
|
||||
|
||||
\begin{methoddesc}[TestCase]{assertRaises}{exception, callable, \moreargs}
|
||||
\methodline{failUnlessRaises}{exception, callable, \moreargs}
|
||||
\methodline[TestCase]{failUnlessRaises}{exception, callable, \moreargs}
|
||||
Test that an exception is raised when \var{callable} is called with
|
||||
any positional or keyword arguments that are also passed to
|
||||
\method{assertRaises()}. The test passes if \var{exception} is
|
||||
|
|
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Loading…
Reference in New Issue